blob: 18ac2c8576c78a60ecb236a8a80d7a6ea81bedd8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4c47d912020-02-07 04:12:19 +01007 2020/02/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-options
626 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-options
629 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100630 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100631 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100632 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100633 - 51degrees-data-file
634 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200635 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200636 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200637 - wurfl-data-file
638 - wurfl-information-list
639 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100641 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100644 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200645 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200647 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100648 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100649 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100650 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200651 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200652 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200653 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200654 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655 - noepoll
656 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000657 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100659 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000661 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100662 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200663 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200664 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200665 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000666 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000667 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200668 - tune.buffers.limit
669 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200670 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200671 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100672 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100679 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100680 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100681 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.session-timeout
683 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200684 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100685 - tune.maxaccept
686 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200687 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200688 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200689 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100690 - tune.rcvbuf.client
691 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100692 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200693 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100694 - tune.sndbuf.client
695 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100696 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100697 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200698 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200700 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200701 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100702 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200703 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100704 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
706 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
707 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100708 - tune.zlib.memlevel
709 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711 * Debugging
712 - debug
713 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714
715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007163.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717------------------------------------
718
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200719ca-base <dir>
720 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200721 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
722 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724chroot <jail dir>
725 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
726 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
727 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
728 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
729 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100731
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
733 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
734 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
735 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
736 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
737 set. These sets have the format
738
739 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
740
741 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100742 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100743 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
744 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100745 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
746 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100748 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100751 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
752 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
753 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
754 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100755
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100756 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
757 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
758 on the machine's word size.
759
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
762 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
763 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
764 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
765 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
766 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767
768 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100769 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
770
771 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
772 # first 4 CPUs
773
774 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
775 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
776 # word size.
777
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100778 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100780 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
781 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
782 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
783
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
785 # and so on.
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
787 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
788 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
789
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100790 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100791 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
792 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
793 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
794
795 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
796 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
797 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
798
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100799 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
800 # and a thread range.
801 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
803 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
804
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200805crt-base <dir>
806 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100807 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
808 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200810daemon
811 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
812 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100813 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
814 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200816deviceatlas-json-file <path>
817 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100818 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200819
820deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100821 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200822 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
823
824deviceatlas-separator <char>
825 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
826 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
827
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100828deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200829 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
830 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
831 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100832
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900833external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100834 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
835 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100836 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
837 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
838 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
839 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
840 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842gid <number>
843 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
844 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
845 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100846 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
847 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200848 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100849
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100850group <group name>
851 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
852 See also "gid" and "user".
853
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100854hard-stop-after <time>
855 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
856
857 Arguments :
858 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
859 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
860 SIGUSR1 signal.
861
862 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
863 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
864 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
865
866 Example:
867 global
868 hard-stop-after 30s
869
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200870h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
871 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
872 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
873 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
874 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
875 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
876 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
877 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
878 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
879 specified in a proxy.
880
881 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
882 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
883 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
884 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
885 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
886 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
887 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
888
889 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
890 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
891 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
892 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
893 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
894
895 Example:
896 global
897 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
898
899 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
900 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
901
902h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
903 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
904 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
905 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
906 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
907 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
908 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
909 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
910 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
911
912 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
913 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
914 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
915
916 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
917 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
918
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100919insecure-fork-wanted
920 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
921 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
922 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
923 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
924 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
925 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
926 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
927 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
928 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
929 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
930 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
931 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
932 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
933 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
934 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
935 disable it.
936
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100937insecure-setuid-wanted
938 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
939 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
940 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
941 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
942 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
943 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
944 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
945 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
946 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
947 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
948 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
949 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
950 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
951 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
952
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100953issuers-chain-path <dir>
954 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
955 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
956 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
957 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
958 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
959 "issuers-chain-path".
960 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
961 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
962 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
963 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
964 will share the chain in memory.
965
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200966log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
967 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100968 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100969 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100970 configured with "log global".
971
972 <address> can be one of:
973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100974 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
976 port).
977
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100978 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100982 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100983 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
984 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
988 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
989 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
990 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
991 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
992 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
993 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
994 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
995 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
996 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
997 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
998 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
999 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1000 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001001 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1002 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003
1004 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1005 "fd@2", see above.
1006
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001007 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1008 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1009 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1010 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1011 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1012
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001013 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1014 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001015
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001016 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1017 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1018 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1019 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1020 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1021 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1022 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1023 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1024 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1025 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001026 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1027 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001028
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001029 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1030 one of the following :
1031
1032 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1033 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1034
1035 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1036 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1037
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001038 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1039 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1040 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1041 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1042 logger consumes.
1043
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001044 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1045 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1046 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1047 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1048
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001049 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1050 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1051 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1052 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1053 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1054
1055 <sample_size>
1056 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1057 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1058 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1059 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1060 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1061
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001062 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001063
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001064 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1065 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1066 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1067
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001068 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1069 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1070 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1071 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072
1073 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001074 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1075 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1076 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1077 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1078 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1079 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001081 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001083log-send-hostname [<string>]
1084 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1085 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1086 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1087 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1088 the logs.
1089
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001090log-tag <string>
1091 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1092 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1093 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001094 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001096lua-load <file>
1097 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1098 used multiple times.
1099
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001100lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1101 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1102 variable.
1103 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1104 to "path".
1105
1106 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1107 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1108 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1109 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1110 will be checked earlier.
1111
1112 As an example by specifying the following path:
1113
1114 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1115 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1116
1117 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1118 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1119 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1120 paths if that does not exist either.
1121
1122 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1123 documentation.
1124
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001125master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001126 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1127 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1128 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001129 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1131 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001132 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1133 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1134 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1135 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1136 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001137
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001138 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001139
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001140mworker-max-reloads <number>
1141 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001142 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001143 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1144 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1145 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1146
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147nbproc <number>
1148 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1149 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1150 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001151 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1152 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001153 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1154 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001155
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001156nbthread <number>
1157 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001158 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1159 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1160 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1161 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1162 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001163 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1164 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1165 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1166 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1167 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1168 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1169 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001172 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001173 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1174 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1175
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001176presetenv <name> <value>
1177 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1178 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1179 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1180 and "unsetenv".
1181
1182resetenv [<name> ...]
1183 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1184 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1185 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1186 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1187 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1188 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1189 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1190 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1191
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001192stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001193 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1194 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1195 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1196 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1197 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1198 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001199 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001200 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1201 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1202 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1203 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001204
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001205server-state-base <directory>
1206 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001207 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1208 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001209
1210server-state-file <file>
1211 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1212 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1213 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1214 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1215 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1216 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1217 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1218 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001219 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1220 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001221
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001222setenv <name> <value>
1223 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1224 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1225 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1226 and "unsetenv".
1227
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001228set-dumpable
1229 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001230 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1231 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1232 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1233 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1234 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1235 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1236 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1237 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1238 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1239 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1240 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1241 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1242 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1243 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1244 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1245 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1246 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001247
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001248ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1250 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001251 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001252 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001253 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1254 information and recommendations see e.g.
1255 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1256 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1257 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1258 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001259
1260ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1262 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1263 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1264 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1265 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001266 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1267 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1268 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001269 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001270
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001271ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1273 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1274 keyword to see available options.
1275
1276 Example:
1277 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001278 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001279
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001280ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1282 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001283 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001284 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1286 information and recommendations see e.g.
1287 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1288 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1289 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1290 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1291 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001292
1293ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1295 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1296 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1297 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1298 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001299 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1300 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1302 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001303
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001304ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1306 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1307 keyword to see available options.
1308
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001309ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1311 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1312 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001313 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001314 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001315 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1316 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1317 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1318 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001319 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1320 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1321 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1322
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001323ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer>*
1324 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1325 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1326
1327 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1328 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1329 optimize the startup time.
1330
1331 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1332 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1333 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1334
1335 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
1336 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer.
1337
1338 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1339 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1340 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1341 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1342 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1343 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
1344 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specifiy both the ECDSA
1345 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1346
1347 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1348
1349 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1350
1351 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1352 not provided in the PEM file.
1353
1354 The default behavior is "all".
1355
1356 Example:
1357 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1358 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1359 ssl-load-extra-files none
1360
1361 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1362
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001363ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1364 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1365 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1366 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1367
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001368stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1369 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1370 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1371 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001372 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001373 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001374
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001375 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1376 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1377 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001378
1379stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1380 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1381 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001382 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001383
1384stats maxconn <connections>
1385 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1386 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1387
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001388uid <number>
1389 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1390 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1391 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1392 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1393
1394ulimit-n <number>
1395 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1396 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1397 option.
1398
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001399unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1400 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1401
1402 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1403 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1404 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1405 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1406 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1407 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1408 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1409 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1410 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1411 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1412
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001413unsetenv [<name> ...]
1414 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1415 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1416 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1417 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1418 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1419 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1420 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1421
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422user <user name>
1423 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1424 See also "uid" and "group".
1425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001426node <name>
1427 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1428
1429 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1430 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1431 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1432 traffic.
1433
1434description <text>
1435 Add a text that describes the instance.
1436
1437 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1438 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1439 "<" and ">" characters.
1440
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100144151degrees-data-file <file path>
1442 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001443 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001444
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001445 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001446 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1447
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000144851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001449 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1450 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1451 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1452
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001453 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001454 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1455
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200145651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001457 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1458 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1459
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001460 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1461 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1462
146351degrees-cache-size <number>
1464 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1465 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1466 By default, this cache is disabled.
1467
1468 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1470
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001471wurfl-data-file <file path>
1472 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1473 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1474
1475 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1476 with USE_WURFL=1.
1477
1478wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1479 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1480 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1481 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1482
1483 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1484
1485 Valid WURFL properties are:
1486 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1487
1488 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1489 device.
1490
1491 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1492 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1493
1494 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1495 particular web request.
1496
1497 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1498 used Libwurfl API version.
1499
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001500 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1501 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1502
1503 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1504 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1505
1506 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1507
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001508 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1509 with USE_WURFL=1.
1510
1511wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1512 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1513 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1514
1515 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1516 with USE_WURFL=1.
1517
1518wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1519 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1520 thus before the chroot.
1521
1522 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1523 with USE_WURFL=1.
1524
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001525wurfl-cache-size <size>
1526 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1527 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001528 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001529 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001530
1531 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1532 with USE_WURFL=1.
1533
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001534strict-limits
1535 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1536 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1537 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1538 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1539 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1540 keyword.
1541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015423.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001543-----------------------
1544
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001545busy-polling
1546 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1547 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1548 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1549 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1550 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1551 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1552 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1553 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1554 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1555 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1556 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1557 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1558 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1559 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1560 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1561 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1562 "poll" pollers.
1563
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001564 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1565 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1566 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1567
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001568max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1569 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1570 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1571 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1572 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1573 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1574 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1575 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1576 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1577
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578maxconn <number>
1579 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1580 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1581 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001582 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1583 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1584 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1585 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001586 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1587 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1588 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1589 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1590 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1591 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001592
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001593maxconnrate <number>
1594 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1595 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1596 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1597 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1598 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1599 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1600 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1601 fairness.
1602
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001603maxcomprate <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001605 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001606 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1607 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1608 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001609 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001610 default value.
1611
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001612maxcompcpuusage <number>
1613 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1614 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1615 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1616 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1617 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1618 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1619 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1620 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1621
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001622maxpipes <number>
1623 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1624 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1625 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1626 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1627 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1628 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1629
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001630maxsessrate <number>
1631 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1632 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1633 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1634 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1635 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1636 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1637 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1638 fairness.
1639
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001640maxsslconn <number>
1641 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1642 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1643 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1644 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1645 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1646 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1647 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001648 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1649 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1650 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1651 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1652 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1653 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1654 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001655
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001656maxsslrate <number>
1657 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1658 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1659 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1660 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1661 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1662 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1663 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1664 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1665 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1666 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1667
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001668maxzlibmem <number>
1669 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1670 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1671 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001672 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1673 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1674 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001676noepoll
1677 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1678 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001679 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001680
1681nokqueue
1682 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1683 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1684 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1685
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001686noevports
1687 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1688 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1689 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1690 also "nopoll".
1691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692nopoll
1693 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1694 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001696 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1697 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001698
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001699nosplice
1700 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001701 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001702 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001703 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001704 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1705 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1706 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1707 "option splice-response".
1708
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001709nogetaddrinfo
1710 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1711 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1712
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001713noreuseport
1714 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1715 command line argument "-dR".
1716
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001717profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1718 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1719 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1720 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1721 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001722 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001723 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1724 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1725 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1726 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1727
1728 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1729 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1730 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1731 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1732 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001733 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1734 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1735 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1736 CLI.
1737
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001738spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001739 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1740 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1741 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1742 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1743 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1744 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001746ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001747 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001749 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1750 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1751 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1752 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1753 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001754 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1755 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001756 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1757 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1758 openssl configuration file uses:
1759 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1760
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001761ssl-mode-async
1762 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001763 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001764 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1765 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1766 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001767 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001768 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001769
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001770tune.buffers.limit <number>
1771 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1772 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1773 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1774 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1775 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001776 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001777 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1778 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1779 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1780 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1781 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1782 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1783 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1784 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1785 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1786
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001787tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1788 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1789 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1790 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1791 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1792
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001793tune.bufsize <number>
1794 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1795 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1796 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1797 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1798 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1799 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1800 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001801 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1802 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1803 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001804 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001805 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1806 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1807 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001808
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001809tune.chksize <number>
1810 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1811 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1812 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1813 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1814 checks whenever possible.
1815
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001816tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1817 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1818 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1819 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1820 this value. The default value is 1.
1821
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001822tune.fail-alloc
1823 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1824 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1825 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1826 gracefully.
1827
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001828tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1829 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1830 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1831 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1832 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1833 change it.
1834
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001835tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1836 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001837 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1838 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001839 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1840 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1841 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1842 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1843 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1844
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001845tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1846 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1847 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1848 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1849 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1850 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1851 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1852 recommended not to change this value.
1853
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001854tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1855 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1856 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1857 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1858 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1859 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1860 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1861 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1862
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001863tune.http.cookielen <number>
1864 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1865 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1866 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1867 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1868 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1869 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1870 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1871 to change this value.
1872
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001873tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001874 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1875 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001876 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001878 configuration directives too.
1879 The default value is 1024.
1880
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001881tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1882 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1883 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1884 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1885 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1886 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1887 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001888 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1889 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1890 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001891
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001892tune.idletimer <timeout>
1893 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1894 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1895 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1896 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1897 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1898 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001900 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001901 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1902
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001903tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1904 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1905 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1906 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1907 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1908 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1909 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1910 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1911 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1912 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1913
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001914tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1915 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001916 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001917 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1918 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001920 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1921 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1922
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001923tune.lua.maxmem
1924 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1925 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1926 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1927 memory.
1928
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001929tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1930 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001931 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1932 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001933 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001934
1935tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1936 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1937 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1938 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1939 check servers.
1940
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001941tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1942 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1943 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1944 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001946
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001947tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001948 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1949 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1950 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1951 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1952 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1953 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1954 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1955 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1956 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1957 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001958
1959tune.maxpollevents <number>
1960 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1961 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1962 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1963 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1964 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1965
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001966tune.maxrewrite <number>
1967 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1968 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1969 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1970 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1971 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1972 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1973 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1974 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1975 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1976 bufsize.
1977
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001978tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1979 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1980 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1981 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1982 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1983 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1984 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1985 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1986 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1987 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001988 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1989 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001990 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1991 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1992 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1993 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1994 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1995 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1996 setting this parameter to 0.
1997
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001998tune.pipesize <number>
1999 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2000 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2001 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2002 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2003 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2004 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2005
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002006tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2007 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2008 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2009 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2010 default is 20.
2011
2012tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2013 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2014 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2015 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2016 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2017 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2018 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002019 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002020
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002021tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2022tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2023 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2024 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2025 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002026 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002027 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002028 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2029 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2030
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002031tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002032 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002033 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2034 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2035 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2036 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2037
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002038tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002039 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002040 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2041 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2042
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002043tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2044tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2045 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2046 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2047 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002048 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002049 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002050 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2051 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2052 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2053 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2054 notifying haproxy again.
2055
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002056tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002057 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2058 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2059 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002060 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002061 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002062 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002063 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2064 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2065 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002066 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2067 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002068
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002069tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002070 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002071 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2072 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2073 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2074 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2075 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2076
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002077tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2078 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002079 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002080 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2081 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2082 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2083 being used for too long.
2084
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002085tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2086 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2087 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2088 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2089 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2090 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2091 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2092 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2093 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2094 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2095 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002096 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002097 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002098
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002099tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2100 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2101 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2102 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2103 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2104 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2105 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2106 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002107 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2108 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002109
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002110tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2111 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2112 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2113 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2114 1000 entries.
2115
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002116tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2117 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2118 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2119 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2120
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002121tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002122tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002123tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2124tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2125tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002126 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2127 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2128 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2129 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2130 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2131 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2132 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2133 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002134
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002135 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2136 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2137 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2138 all available space is consumed.
2139 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2140 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2141 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002142
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002143tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2144 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002145 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002146 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002147 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002148 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2149
2150tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2151 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2152 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002153 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2154 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021563.3. Debugging
2157--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002158
2159debug
2160 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2161 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2162 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2163 system startup.
2164
2165quiet
2166 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2167 line argument "-q".
2168
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021703.4. Userlists
2171--------------
2172It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2173http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2174it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2175
2176userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002177 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002178 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2179
2180group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002181 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002182 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2183 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2184
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002185user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2186 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002187 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2188 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002189 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2190 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2191 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2192 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002193
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002194 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2195 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2196 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2197 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2198 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2199 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2200 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2201 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2202 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002203
2204 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002205 userlist L1
2206 group G1 users tiger,scott
2207 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002208
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002209 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2210 user scott insecure-password elgato
2211 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002212
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002213 userlist L2
2214 group G1
2215 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2218 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2219 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220
2221 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002222
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002223
22243.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002225----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002226It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2227several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2228instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2229values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2230automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2231In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2232using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2233tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2234reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2235Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2236that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2237each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002238
2239peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002240 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002241 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2242
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002243bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2244 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2245 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2246
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002247disabled
2248 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2249 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2250 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2251
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002252default-bind [param*]
2253 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2254
2255default-server [param*]
2256 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2257
2258 Arguments:
2259 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2260 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2261 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2262 details.
2263
2264
2265 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2266
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002267enable
2268 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2269
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002270log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2271 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2272 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2273 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2274 more details.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002277 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2278 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2279 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2280 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2281 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2282 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2283
2284 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2285 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2286
2287 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2288 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2289 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2290 across all peers.
2291
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002292 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2293 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002294
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002295 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2296 "server" keyword explanation below).
2297
2298server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002299 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002300 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2301 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2302 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2303 of this "peers" section).
2304 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2305
2306
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002307 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002310 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2311 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2312 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002313
2314 backend mybackend
2315 mode tcp
2316 balance roundrobin
2317 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2318 stick on src
2319
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002320 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2321 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002322
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002323 Example:
2324 peers mypeers
2325 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2326 default-server ssl verify none
2327 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2328 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002329
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002330
2331table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2332 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2333
2334 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2335 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002336 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002337 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2338 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2339 "stick-table" keyword).
2340
2341 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2342 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2343 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2344 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2345 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2346 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2347 of the stick-table name as follows:
2348
2349 peers mypeers
2350 peer A ...
2351 peer B ...
2352 table t1 ...
2353
2354 frontend fe1
2355 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2356
2357 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2358 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2359
2360 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2361 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2362 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2363 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2364 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2365 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2366 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2367
2368 peers mypeers
2369 peer A ...
2370 peer B ...
2371 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2372
2373 backend t1
2374 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2375
2376 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2377 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2378 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2379
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023803.6. Mailers
2381------------
2382It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2383If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2384in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2385
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002386mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002387 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2388 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2389
2390mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2391 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2392
2393 Example:
2394 mailers mymailers
2395 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2396 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2397
2398 backend mybackend
2399 mode tcp
2400 balance roundrobin
2401
2402 email-alert mailers mymailers
2403 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2404 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2405
2406 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2407 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2408
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002409timeout mail <time>
2410 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2411 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2412 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2413 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2414
2415 Example:
2416 mailers mymailers
2417 timeout mail 20s
2418 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024203.7. Programs
2421-------------
2422In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2423master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2424managed the same way as the workers.
2425
2426During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2427sequence as a worker:
2428
2429 - the master is re-executed
2430 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2431 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2432 instance of the program
2433
2434During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2435
2436program <name>
2437 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2438 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2439 the management guide).
2440
2441command <command> [arguments*]
2442 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2443 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2444 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2445 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2446
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002447user <user name>
2448 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2449 See also "group".
2450
2451group <group name>
2452 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2453 See also "user".
2454
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002455option start-on-reload
2456no option start-on-reload
2457 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2458 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2459 program section.
2460
2461
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024623.8. HTTP-errors
2463----------------
2464
2465It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2466imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2467several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2468
2469http-errors <name>
2470 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2471 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2472
2473errorfile <code> <file>
2474 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2475
2476 Arguments :
2477 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2478 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2479 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2480
2481 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2482 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2483 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2484 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2485 before any chroot is performed.
2486
2487 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2488
2489 Example:
2490 http-errors website-1
2491 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2492 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2493 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2494
2495 http-errors website-2
2496 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2497 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2498 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2499
2500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025014. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002502----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002504Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002505 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002506 - frontend <name>
2507 - backend <name>
2508 - listen <name>
2509
2510A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2511its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2512section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002514
2515A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2516connections.
2517
2518A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2519to forward incoming connections.
2520
2521A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2522parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2525'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2526case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2527
2528Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2529logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2530proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2531However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2532name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2533
2534Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2535and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002536bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2538modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2539arbitrary criteria.
2540
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002541In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2542a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002543the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002544
2545 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2546 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2547 between responses and new requests.
2548
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002549 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2550 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2551 client-facing connection remains open.
2552
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002553 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2554 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002555
2556The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2557frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2558following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002559weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002560
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002561 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002562
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002563 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2564 ----+-----+-----+----
2565 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2566 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002567 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2568 ----+-----+-----+----
2569 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002570
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025734.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2574--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002576The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2577limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2578they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2579limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002580marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002581option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002582and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2583with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2584specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002585
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002586
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002587 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002590backlog X X X -
2591balance X - X X
2592bind - X X -
2593bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002594capture cookie - X X -
2595capture request header - X X -
2596capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002597compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002599declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600default-server X - X X
2601default_backend X X X -
2602description - X X X
2603disabled X X X X
2604dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002605email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002606email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002607email-alert mailers X X X X
2608email-alert myhostname X X X X
2609email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610enabled X X X X
2611errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002612errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002613errorloc X X X X
2614errorloc302 X X X X
2615-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2616errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002617force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002618filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619fullconn X - X X
2620grace X X X X
2621hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002622http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002624http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002625http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002627http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002628http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002629http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002631ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002632load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002633log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002634log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002635log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002636log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002637max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002638maxconn X X X -
2639mode X X X X
2640monitor fail - X X -
2641monitor-net X X X -
2642monitor-uri X X X -
2643option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2644option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2645option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2646option allbackups (*) X - X X
2647option checkcache (*) X - X X
2648option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2649option contstats (*) X X X -
2650option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2651option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2653option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002654option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2655option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002656option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002657option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002658option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002659option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002660option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002661option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2662option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2663option httpchk X - X X
2664option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002665option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002667option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002668option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002669option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002670option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2671option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2672option logasap (*) X X X -
2673option mysql-check X - X X
2674option nolinger (*) X X X X
2675option originalto X X X X
2676option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002677option pgsql-check X - X X
2678option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002679option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002680option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002681option smtpchk X - X X
2682option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2683option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2684option splice-request (*) X X X X
2685option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002686option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002687option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2688option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2689-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002690option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002691option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2692option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2693option tcpka X X X X
2694option tcplog X X X X
2695option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002696external-check command X - X X
2697external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2699rate-limit sessions X X X -
2700redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002703retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002704server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002705server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002706server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002707source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002708stats admin - X X X
2709stats auth X X X X
2710stats enable X X X X
2711stats hide-version X X X X
2712stats http-request - X X X
2713stats realm X X X X
2714stats refresh X X X X
2715stats scope X X X X
2716stats show-desc X X X X
2717stats show-legends X X X X
2718stats show-node X X X X
2719stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002720-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2721stick match - - X X
2722stick on - - X X
2723stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002724stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002725stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002726tcp-check connect - - X X
2727tcp-check expect - - X X
2728tcp-check send - - X X
2729tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002730tcp-request connection - X X -
2731tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002732tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002733tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002734tcp-response content - - X X
2735tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736timeout check X - X X
2737timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002738timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002740timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2741timeout http-request X X X X
2742timeout queue X - X X
2743timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002744timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002745timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002746timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002747transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002748unique-id-format X X X -
2749unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002750use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002751use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002752use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002753------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2754 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2758---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2761
2762
2763acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2764 Declare or complete an access list.
2765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2766 no | yes | yes | yes
2767 Example:
2768 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2769 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2770 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002772 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002773
2774
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002775backlog <conns>
2776 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2778 yes | yes | yes | no
2779 Arguments :
2780 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2781 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002782 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002783
2784 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2785 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2786 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2787 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2788 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2789 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2790 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2791 backlog parameter.
2792
2793 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2794 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2795 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2796
2797 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2798
2799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002800balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002801balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002802 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 yes | no | yes | yes
2805 Arguments :
2806 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2807 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2808 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2809 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2810
2811 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2812 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2813 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2814 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002815 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002816 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002817 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2818 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2819 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2820 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2821 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2822 it, so that you don't worry.
2823
2824 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2825 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2826 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2827 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2828 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2829 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2830 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2831 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002833 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2834 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2835 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2836 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2837 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2838 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2839 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2840 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2841
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002842 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002843 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002844 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2845 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002846 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002847 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2848 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2849 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2850 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2851 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002852 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2853 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2854 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2855 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2856 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2857 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2860 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2861 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2862 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2863 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2864 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2865 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2866 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002867 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002869 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2870 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2871 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002873 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2874 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2875 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2876 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2877 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2878 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2879 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2880 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2881 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2882 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2883 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2884 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002886 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002887 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2888 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2889 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2890 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2891 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2892 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2893 URIs start with a leading "/".
2894
2895 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2896 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2897 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2898 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002901 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2902
2903 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002904 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2905 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002906 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2907 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2908 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2909 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002910 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002911 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2912 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002913
2914 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2915 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2916 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2917 server will receive the request.
2918
2919 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2920 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2921 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2922 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2923 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002924 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2925 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2926 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002927
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002928 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2929 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2930 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2931 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2932 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002934 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002935 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2936 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2937 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2938
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002939 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2940 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2941 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2942
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002943 random
2944 random(<draws>)
2945 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002946 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2947 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2948 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2949 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002950 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2951 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2952 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2953 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2954 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2955 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2956 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2957 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2958 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2959 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2960 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2961 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2962 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2963 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2964 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2965 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2966 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2967 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2968 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2969 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002970
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002971 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002972 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002973 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2974 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2975 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2976 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2977 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2978 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002979 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002980 used instead.
2981
2982 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2983 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2984 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2985 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2986
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002987 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2988 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2989 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2990
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002991 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002992
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002994 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2995 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002996
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002997 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2998 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2999 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003001 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003002 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003003 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3004 NTLM relies on.
3005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 Examples :
3007 balance roundrobin
3008 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003009 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003010 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3011 balance hdr(host)
3012 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003013
3014 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3015 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003017 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003018 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3019 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3020 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003021 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003022
3023 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3024 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3025 defaults to 16 kB.
3026
3027 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3028 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3029
3030 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3031 Round Robin.
3032
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003033 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003034 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3035 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3036 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3037
3038 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3039
3040 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003041 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003042 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3043 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3044 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003046 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047
3048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003049bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3050bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 no | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003055 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3056 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3057 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3058 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003059 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003060 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3061 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3062 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3063 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3064 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3065 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3066 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003067 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3068 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3069 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3070 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3071 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3072 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3073 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003074 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3075 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3076 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003077 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3078 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3079 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3080 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003081 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3082 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3083 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003084
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003085 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3086 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003087 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3088 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3089 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003090 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3091 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3092 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3093 the range.
3094
3095 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3096 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3097 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3098 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3099 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3100 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3101 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003102 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003103 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003105 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003106 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003107 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3108 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3109 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3110 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3111 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3112 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3113
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003114 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3115 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3116 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3117 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003118
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3120 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3121 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3122 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3123 in a frontend.
3124
3125 Example :
3126 listen http_proxy
3127 bind :80,:443
3128 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003129 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003131 listen http_https_proxy
3132 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003133 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003134
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003135 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3136 bind ipv6@:80
3137 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3138 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3139
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003140 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003141 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003142
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003143 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3144 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3145 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3146 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3147 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3148
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003149 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003150 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
3152
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003153bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003154 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3156 yes | yes | yes | yes
3157 Arguments :
3158 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3159 may be used to override a default value.
3160
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003161 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003162 option may be combined with other numbers.
3163
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003164 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003165 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3166 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3167 missing from all processes.
3168
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003169 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003170 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003171 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3172 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3173 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3174 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3175 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003176 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003177
3178 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3179 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3180 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3181 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3182 and 'even' instances.
3183
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003184 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3185 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3186 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3187 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003188
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003189 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3190 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3191
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003192 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3193 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3194 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3195
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003196 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3197 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3198
3199 Example :
3200 listen app_ip1
3201 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003202 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203
3204 listen app_ip2
3205 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003206 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003207
3208 listen management
3209 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003210 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003211
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003212 listen management
3213 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3214 bind-process 1-4
3215
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003216 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003217
3218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219capture cookie <name> len <length>
3220 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3222 no | yes | yes | no
3223 Arguments :
3224 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3225 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3226 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3227 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003228 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229
3230 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3231 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3232 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3233 right if it exceeds <length>.
3234
3235 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3236 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3237 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3238 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3239
3240 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3241 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3242 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3243
3244 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3245 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3246 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003247 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3248 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3249 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003250
3251 Example:
3252 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3253
3254 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003255 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003256
3257
3258capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003259 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3261 no | yes | yes | no
3262 Arguments :
3263 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003264 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003265 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3266 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3267 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3268
3269 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3270 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3271 it exceeds <length>.
3272
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003273 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3275 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003276 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3277 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3278 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3279 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003280 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003281 environments to find where the request came from.
3282
3283 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3284 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3285 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3286 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003287
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003288 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3289 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3290 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3291 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3292 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
3294 Example:
3295 capture request header Host len 15
3296 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003297 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003299 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 about logging.
3301
3302
3303capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003304 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3306 no | yes | yes | no
3307 Arguments :
3308 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003309 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3311 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3312 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3313
3314 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3315 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3316 it exceeds <length>.
3317
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003318 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3320 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3321 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003322 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3323 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3324 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3325 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003327 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3328 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3329 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3330 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3331 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332
3333 Example:
3334 capture response header Content-length len 9
3335 capture response header Location len 15
3336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003337 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338 about logging.
3339
3340
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003341compression algo <algorithm> ...
3342compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003343compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003344 Enable HTTP compression.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | yes | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003348 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3349 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3350 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3351
3352 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003353 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3354 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3355 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003356
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003357 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003358 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003359
3360 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3361 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3362 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3363 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3364 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003365 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003366
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003367 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3368 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3369 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3370 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3371 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3372 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3373 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003374 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003375
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003376 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003377 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003378 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3379 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3380 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3381 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3382 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003383
3384 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3385 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3386 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3387 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3388 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003389 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3390 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3391 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3392 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3393 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003394 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3395 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003396
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003397 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003398 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3399 "Accept-Encoding" header
3400 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003401 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003402 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3403 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3404 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3405 "multipart"
3406 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3407 header
3408 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3409 and later
3410 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3411 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003412 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003413
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003414 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003415
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003416 Examples :
3417 compression algo gzip
3418 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003420
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003421cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003422 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3423 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003424 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 yes | no | yes | yes
3428 Arguments :
3429 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3430 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3431 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3432 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3433 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3434 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003435 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3437 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3438
3439 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3440 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3441 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3442 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3443 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3444 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003445 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3446 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003447 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003448 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3449 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450
3451 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003452 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003453
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003454 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003455 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003456 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003457 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003458 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3459 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3460 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3461 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3462 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3463 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3464 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
3466 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3467 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3468 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3469 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3470 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3471 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3472 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3473 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3474 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003475 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003476 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3477 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3478 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003480 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3481 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3482 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003483 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3484 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3485 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3486 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003487 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3488 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3489 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3492 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3493 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3494 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3495 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3496 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3497 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3498 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3499 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3500
3501 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3502 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3503 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3504 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3505 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3506 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3507 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3508 persistence cookie in the cache.
3509 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3510
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003511 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3512 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3513 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3514 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3515 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003516 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003517 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3518 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3519 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3520 they logout.
3521
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003522 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3523 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3524 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3525 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3526
3527 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3528 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3529 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3530 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3531 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3532 this attribute.
3533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003534 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003535 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003536 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3537 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3538 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3539 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3540 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3541 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003542
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003543 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3544 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3545 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3546 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3547 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3548 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3549 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3550 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003551 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003552 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3553 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3554 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3555 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3556 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3557 the site.
3558
3559 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3560 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3561 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3562 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3563 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3564 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3565 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3566 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3567 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3568 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3569 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3570 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3571 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003572 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003573 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3574 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3575
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003576 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3577 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3578 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3579 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3580 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3581 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3582
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003583 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3584 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3585 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3586 repeated.
3587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3589 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3590 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3591 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003593 Examples :
3594 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3595 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3596 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003597 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003599 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003601
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003602declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3603 Declares a capture slot.
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 no | yes | yes | no
3606 Arguments:
3607 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3608
3609 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3610 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3611 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3612 for use in the response.
3613
3614 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003615 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003616 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3617
3618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003619default-server [param*]
3620 Change default options for a server in a backend
3621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3622 yes | no | yes | yes
3623 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003624 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3625 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3626 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3627 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003628
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003629 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003630 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3631
3632 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635default_backend <backend>
3636 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | yes | yes | no
3639 Arguments :
3640 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3641
3642 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3643 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3644 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3645 will catch all undetermined requests.
3646
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647 Example :
3648
3649 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3650 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3651 default_backend dynamic
3652
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003653 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003656description <string>
3657 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3659 no | yes | yes | yes
3660 Arguments : string
3661
3662 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3663 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3664 it describes.
3665 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3666
3667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668disabled
3669 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3671 yes | yes | yes | yes
3672 Arguments : none
3673
3674 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3675 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3676 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3677 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3678 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3679 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3680 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3681
3682 See also : "enabled"
3683
3684
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003685dispatch <address>:<port>
3686 Set a default server address
3687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3688 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003689 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003690
3691 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3692 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3693 during start-up.
3694
3695 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3696 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3697 possible with normal servers.
3698
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003699 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003700 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3701 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3702 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3703 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3704
3705 See also : "server"
3706
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003707
3708dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3709 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | no | yes | yes
3712 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3713
3714 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003715 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003716 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3717 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003718 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003719 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003721enabled
3722 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3724 yes | yes | yes | yes
3725 Arguments : none
3726
3727 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3728 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3729
3730 See also : "disabled"
3731
3732
3733errorfile <code> <file>
3734 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3736 yes | yes | yes | yes
3737 Arguments :
3738 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003739 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3740 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003741
3742 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003743 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003745 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3746 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003747
3748 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3749 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3750 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3751
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003752 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3755 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3756 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3757 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3758
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003759 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3760 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003761 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003762 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3763 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3764 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003766 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3767 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3768 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003769 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003770 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3771
3772 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3773
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003774 Example :
3775 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003776 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003777 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3778 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3779
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003780
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003781errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3782 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3783 section.
3784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3785 yes | yes | yes | yes
3786 Arguments :
3787 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3788
3789 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3790 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3791 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3792
3793 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3794 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3795 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3796 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3797 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3798 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3799 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3800
3801 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3802 3.8 about http-errors.
3803
3804 Example :
3805 errorfiles generic
3806 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3807
3808
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003809errorloc <code> <url>
3810errorloc302 <code> <url>
3811 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | yes | yes | yes
3814 Arguments :
3815 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003816 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3817 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003818
3819 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3820 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3821 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3822 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003823 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003824
3825 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3826 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3827 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3828
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003829 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3830
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003831 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3832 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3833 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3834 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003835 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003836 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3837 request.
3838
3839 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3840
3841
3842errorloc303 <code> <url>
3843 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | yes | yes | yes
3846 Arguments :
3847 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003848 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3849 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850
3851 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3852 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3853 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3854 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003855 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856
3857 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3858 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3859 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3860
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003861 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3864 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3865 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3866 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003867 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003868
3869 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3870
3871
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003872email-alert from <emailaddr>
3873 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003874 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | yes
3877
3878 Arguments :
3879
3880 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3881
3882 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3883 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3884
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003885 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003886 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3887 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003888
3889
3890email-alert level <level>
3891 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3892 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3894 yes | yes | yes | yes
3895
3896 Arguments :
3897
3898 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3899 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3900 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3901
3902 By default level is alert
3903
3904 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3905 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3906 for the proxy.
3907
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003908 Alerts are sent when :
3909
3910 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3911 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3912 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3913 is notice or lower
3914 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3915 and a health check status update occurs
3916
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003917 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3918 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003919 section 3.6 about mailers.
3920
3921
3922email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3923 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3925 yes | yes | yes | yes
3926
3927 Arguments :
3928
3929 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3930
3931 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3932 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3933
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003934 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3935 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003936
3937
3938email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3939 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3940 mailers.
3941 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3942 yes | yes | yes | yes
3943
3944 Arguments :
3945
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003946 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003947
3948 By default the systems hostname is used.
3949
3950 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3951 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3952 for the proxy.
3953
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003954 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3955 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003956
3957
3958email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003959 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003960 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3962 yes | yes | yes | yes
3963
3964 Arguments :
3965
3966 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3967
3968 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3969 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3970
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003971 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003972 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3973
3974
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003975force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3976 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003978 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003979
3980 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3981 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3982 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3983 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3984 marked down for maintenance operations.
3985
3986 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3987 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3988 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3989 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3990 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3991 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3992 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3993 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3994 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3995
3996 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3997 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3998 is used.
3999
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004000 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004001 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004002
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004003
4004filter <name> [param*]
4005 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 no | yes | yes | yes
4008 Arguments :
4009 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4010 referenced in section 9.
4011
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004012 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004013 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004014 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4015 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004016
4017 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4018 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4019
4020 Example:
4021 listen
4022 bind *:80
4023
4024 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4025 filter compression
4026 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4027
4028 compression algo gzip
4029 compression offload
4030
4031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4032
4033 See also : section 9.
4034
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004035
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036fullconn <conns>
4037 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | no | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4042 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4043
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004044 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004045 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004046 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004047 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4048 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4049 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4050 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4051 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004052 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004053
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004054 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4055 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004056 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4057 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4058 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004059
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004060 Example :
4061 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4062 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4063 # connections.
4064 backend dynamic
4065 fullconn 10000
4066 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4067 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4068
4069 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4070
4071
4072grace <time>
4073 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004075 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004076 Arguments :
4077 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4078 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4079 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4080
4081 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4082 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004083 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004084 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4085
4086 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4087 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4088 simplify it.
4089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004091hash-balance-factor <factor>
4092 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4094 yes | no | no | yes
4095 Arguments :
4096 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4097 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004098 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004099
4100 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4101 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4102 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4103 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4104 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4105 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4106 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4107
4108 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4109 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4110 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4111 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4112 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4113
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004114 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4115 consistent hashing mechanism.
4116
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004117 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4118
4119
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004120hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004121 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | no | yes | yes
4124 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004125 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4126 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004127
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004128 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4129 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4130 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4131 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4132 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4133 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4134 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4135 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4136 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4137 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004138
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004139 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4140 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4141 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4142 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4143 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4144 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4145 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4146 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4147 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4148 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4149 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4150 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4151 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004152 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4153 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004154
4155 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4156
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004157 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004158 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4159 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4160 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004161 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4162 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4163 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004164
4165 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4166 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004167 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4168 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4169 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4170 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4171
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004172 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4173 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4174 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4175 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4176 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4177 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4178 parameter.
4179
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004180 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4181 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4182 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4183 used on strings.
4184
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004185 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4186
4187 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4188 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4189 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4190 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4191 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4192 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4193 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4194 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4195 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4196 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4197 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4198 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004199
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004200 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4201 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4202 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004203
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004204 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004205
4206
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004207http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4208 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4209 ones).
4210
4211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 no | yes | yes | yes
4213
4214 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4215 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4216 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4217 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4218 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4219 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4220
4221 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4222 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4223 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4224
4225 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4226 below.
4227
4228 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4229 instance.
4230
4231 Example:
4232 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4233 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4234 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4235
4236http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4237
4238 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4239 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4240 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4241 example, or to pass some internal information.
4242 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4243 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4244 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4245
4246http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4247
4248 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4249 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4250
4251http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4252
4253 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4254
4255http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4256 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4257
4258 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4259
4260 Example:
4261 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4262
4263 # applied to:
4264 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4265
4266 # outputs:
4267 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4268
4269 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4270
4271http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4273
4274 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4275
4276 Example:
4277 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4278
4279 # applied to:
4280 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4281
4282 # outputs:
4283 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4284
4285http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4286
4287 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4288 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4289 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4290
4291http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4293
4294 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4295 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4296 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4297 fallback.
4298
4299 Example:
4300 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4301 http-response set-status 431
4302 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4303 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4304
4305http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4306
4307 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4308 inline.
4309
4310 Arguments:
4311 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4312 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4313 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4314 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4315 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4316 (request and response)
4317 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4318 processing
4319 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4320 processing
4321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4322 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4323 and '_'.
4324
4325 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4326 followed by some converters.
4327
4328 Example:
4329 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4330
4331http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4332
4333 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4334 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4335 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4336 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4337 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4338 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
4339 processing.
4340
4341 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4342 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4343 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4344 rules evaluation.
4345
4346http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4347
4348 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4349 details about <var-name>.
4350
4351 Example:
4352 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4353
4354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004355http-check disable-on-404
4356 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004358 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004359 Arguments : none
4360
4361 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4362 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4363 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4364 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4365 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4366 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4367 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4368 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004369 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4370 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4371 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4372
4373 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4374
4375
4376http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004377 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004379 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004380 Arguments :
4381 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4382 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004383 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004384 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4385 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4386 details on the supported keywords.
4387
4388 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4389 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4390 with the usual backslash ('\').
4391
4392 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4393 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4394 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4395 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4396 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4397
4398 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004399 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004400 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4401 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4402 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4403
4404 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004405 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004406 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4407 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4408 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4409 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4410
4411 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004412 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004413 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4414 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4415 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4416 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4417 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004418 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004419 trace).
4420
4421 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004422 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004423 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4424 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4425 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4426 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4427 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004428 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004429
4430 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4431 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4432 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4433 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4434 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4435 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4436 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4437 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4438
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004439 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4440 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4441 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4442
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004443 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4444 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4445
4446 Examples :
4447 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004448 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004449
4450 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004451 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004452
4453 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004454 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004455
4456 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004457 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004459 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004460
4461
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004462http-check send-state
4463 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4465 yes | no | yes | yes
4466 Arguments : none
4467
4468 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4469 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4470 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4471 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4472 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4473
4474 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4475 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4476 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4477 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4478 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004479 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4480 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4481 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4482
4483 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4484 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4485 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4486
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004487 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4488 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4489 checked in multiple backends.
4490
4491 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4492 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4493
4494 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4495 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4496 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4497 one fails.
4498
4499 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4500 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4501 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4502
4503 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4504 server's queue.
4505
4506 Example of a header received by the application server :
4507 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4508 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4509
4510 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004512
4513http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004514 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4515
4516 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4517 no | yes | yes | yes
4518
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004519 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4520 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4521 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4522 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4523 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4526 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 Example:
4531 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4532 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4533 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535 http-request allow if nagios
4536 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4537 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4538 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 Example:
4541 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4542 acl add path /addacl
4543 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004545 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4548 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004550 Example:
4551 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4552 acl setmap path /setmap
4553 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004555 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4558 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4561 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004565 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4566 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4567 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4568 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4569 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4570 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4571 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4572 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4577 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4578 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4579 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4580 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4581 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4582 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4583 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4588 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004589
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4594 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4595 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4596 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4597 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599 Example:
4600 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4601 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004602
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004603http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004604
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004605 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4608 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004610 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4611 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4612 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4613 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4614 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4615 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4616 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4617 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4618 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4621 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4622 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004623 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4624
4625 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4626 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4627 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4628 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004630http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4633 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4634 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4635 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4636 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4637 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4646 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4647 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4648 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4649 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4650 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004651
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004652http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4653 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4656 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4657 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004658 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4659 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4660 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4661 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4662 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004664
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004665http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4666 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4667 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4668 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4669
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004670http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4671
4672 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4673 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4674 pointed by <resolvers>.
4675 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4676 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4677 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4678 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4679 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4680 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4681 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4682 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4683 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4684 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4685 to 0.0.0.0.
4686
4687 Example:
4688 resolvers mydns
4689 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4690 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4691 timeout retry 1s
4692 hold valid 10s
4693 hold nx 3s
4694 hold other 3s
4695 hold obsolete 0s
4696 accepted_payload_size 8192
4697
4698 frontend fe
4699 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4700 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4701 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4702
4703 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4704 # which mean DNS resolution error
4705 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4706
4707 default_backend be
4708
4709 backend b_503
4710 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4711 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4712 # 503 error page to end users
4713
4714 backend be
4715 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4716 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4717 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4718 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4719 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4720
4721 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4722 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4723
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004724http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4725
4726 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4727 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4728 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4729 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004730 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4731 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004732
4733 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004737 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4738 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4739 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4740 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4741 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004745 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4746 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4747 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4748 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004750http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4751 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004752
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004753 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4754 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4755 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4756 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4757 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4758 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004759
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004760 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4761 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4762 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4763 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4764 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004765
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004766 Example:
4767 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4768
4769 # applied to:
4770 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4771
4772 # outputs:
4773 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4774
4775 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004776
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004777 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4778
4779 # applied to:
4780 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004781
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004782 # outputs:
4783 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004784
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004785http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4786 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4787
4788 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4789 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4790 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4791 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4792
4793 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4794 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4795 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4796
4797 Example:
4798 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4799 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4800
4801 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4802 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4803
4804 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4805 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4806 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4807 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4808
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004809http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4810 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004812 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4813 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4814 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4815 against.
4816
4817 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4818 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4819 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004820
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004821 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4822 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4823 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4824 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4825 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4826 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4827 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4828 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4829 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004830 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4831 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004832
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004833 Example:
4834 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4835 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004836
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004837 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4838 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004840http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4841 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004842
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004843 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4844 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4845 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4846 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004847
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004848 Example:
4849 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004850
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004851 # applied to:
4852 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004853
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004854 # outputs:
4855 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004856
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004857http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4858 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4859 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004860 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4862
4863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediatly returns a response. The
4864 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4865 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4866 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4867 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
4868 or the response payload specifing the file or the string to use. These rules
4869 are followed to create the response :
4870
4871 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4872 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4873 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4874 ignored.
4875
4876 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4877 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4878 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4879 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4880 ignored.
4881
4882 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4883 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4884 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4885 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4886 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4887
4888 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4889 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4890 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4891 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4892 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4893 if any, is ignored.
4894
4895 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4896 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4897 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4898 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4899 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4900 as a raw content.
4901
4902 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4903 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4904 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4905 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4906 considered as a raw string.
4907
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004908 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4909 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4910 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4911 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4912
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004913 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4914 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4915 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4916
4917 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4918
4919 Example:
4920 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4921 if { path /ping }
4922
4923 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4924 if { path /favicon.ico }
4925
4926 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4927 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4928 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004930http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004933 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4934 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4935 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004936
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004937http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4938 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004939
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004940 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4941 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4942 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4943 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004945http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004947 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4948 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4949 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4950 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4951 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004953 Arguments:
4954 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4955 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004957 Example:
4958 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4959 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004961 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4962 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004963
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004964http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004966 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4967 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4968 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004970 Arguments:
4971 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4972 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004974 Example:
4975 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4976 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004978 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4979 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4980 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004982http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004984 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4985 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4986 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4987 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4988 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004989
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004990 Example:
4991 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4992 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4993 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4994 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4995 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4996 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4997 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4998 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4999 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005001http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005003 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5004 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5005 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5006 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5007 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005009http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5010 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005012 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5013 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5014 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5015 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5016 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5017 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5018 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5019 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5020 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005022http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005024 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5025 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5026 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5027 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5028 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5029 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5030 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005032http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005034 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5035 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5036 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005038http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005040 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5041 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5042 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5043 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5044 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5045 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5046 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5047 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005049http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005051 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5052 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5053 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5054 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5055 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5056 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005058 Example :
5059 # prepend the host name before the path
5060 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005062http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5065 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5066 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5067 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5068 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005070http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005072 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5073 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5074 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5075 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5076 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5077 values have higher priority.
5078 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5079 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5080 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5081 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5082 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005084http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5087 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5088 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5089 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5090 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5091 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5092 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005095
5096 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5098 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005100http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5101 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5102 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5103 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
5104 privacy.
5105
5106 Arguments :
5107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5108 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005109
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005110 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005111 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5112 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5113
5114 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5115 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5116
5117http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5118
5119 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5120 expression.
5121
5122 Arguments:
5123 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5124 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005125
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005126 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005127 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5128 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5129
5130 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5131 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5132 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5133
5134http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5135
5136 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5137 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5138 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5139 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5140 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5141 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5142 information from the request.
5143
5144 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5145
5146http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5147
5148 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5149 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5150 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5151 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5152 path and the query string.
5153 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5154
5155http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5156
5157 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5158 inline.
5159
5160 Arguments:
5161 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5162 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5163 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5164 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5165 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5166 (request and response)
5167 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5168 processing
5169 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5170 processing
5171 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5172 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5173 and '_'.
5174
5175 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5176 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005177
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005178 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005179 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005181http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5182 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005184 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5185 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5186 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5187 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5188 agent name must be used.
5189
5190 Arguments:
5191 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5192
5193 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5194 configuration.
5195
5196http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5197
5198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5199 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5200 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5201 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5202 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5203 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5204 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5205 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5206 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5207 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5208 action.
5209 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5210 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5211 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5212 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5213 you fully understand how it works.
5214
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005215http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5216
5217 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5218 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5219 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5220 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5221 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5222 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
5223 processing.
5224
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005225 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005226 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5227 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5228 rules evaluation.
5229
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005230http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005232
5233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5234 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5235 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5236 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5237 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5238 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5239 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5240 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5241 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5242 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5243 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005244 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5245 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5246 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5247 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5248 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005249 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5250
5251http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5252http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5253http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5254
5255 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5256 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5257 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5258 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5259 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5260 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5261 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5262 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5263 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5264 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5265 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5266 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5267
5268 Arguments :
5269 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5270 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5271 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5272 select which table entry to update the counters.
5273
5274 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5275 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5276 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5277 that table until the session ends.
5278
5279 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5280 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5281 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5282 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5283 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5284 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5285 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5286 useful information.
5287
5288 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5289 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5290 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5291 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5292 checks that make use of it.
5293
5294http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5295
5296 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005297
5298 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005299 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005300
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005301http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5302
5303 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5304 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5305 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5306 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5307 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5308 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5309
5310 Arguments :
5311 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5312
5313 Example:
5314 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005316http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005318 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5319 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5320 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005321
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005323http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005324 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5325
5326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5327 no | yes | yes | yes
5328
5329 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5330 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5331 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5332 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5333 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5334 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005336 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5337 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005338
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005339 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005341 Example:
5342 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005343
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005344 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005346 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5347 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005349 Example:
5350 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005352 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005354 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5355 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005357 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5358 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005360http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005362 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5363 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5364 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5365 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5366 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5367 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5368 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5369 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005370
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005371http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005372
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005373 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5374 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5375 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5376 example, or to pass some internal information.
5377 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5378 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5379 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005380
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005381http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5384 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005385
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005386http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005387
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005388 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005389
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005390http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005391
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005392 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5393 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5394 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5395 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5396 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5397 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5398 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005400 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5401 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5402 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5403 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5404 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005405
5406 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5407 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5408 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5409 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005410
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005411http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005413 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5414 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5415 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5416 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5417 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5418 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005420http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005422 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005424http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5427 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5428 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5429 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5430 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5431 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005432
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005433http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5434 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005436 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005437 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5438 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005439 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5440 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5441 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5442 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5443 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005444 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005446http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005448 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5449 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5450 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5451 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5452 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5453 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005454
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005455http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5456 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005458 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5459 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 Example:
5462 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005464 # applied to:
5465 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005466
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005467 # outputs:
5468 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005469
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005470 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005471
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005472http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005474
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005475 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005476 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005477
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005478 Example:
5479 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005480
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005481 # applied to:
5482 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005483
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005484 # outputs:
5485 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005486
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005487http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5488 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5489 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005490 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005491 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5492
5493 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediatly returns a response. The
5494 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5495 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5496 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5497 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
5498 or the response payload specifing the file or the string to use. These rules
5499 are followed to create the response :
5500
5501 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5502 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5503 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5504 ignored.
5505
5506 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5507 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5508 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5509 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5510 ignored.
5511
5512 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5513 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5514 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5515 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5516 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5517
5518 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5519 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5520 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5521 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5522 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5523 if any, is ignored.
5524
5525 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5526 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5527 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5528 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5529 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5530 as a raw content.
5531
5532 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5533 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5534 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5535 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5536 considered as a raw string.
5537
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005538 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5539 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5540 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5541 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5542
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005543 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5544 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5545 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5546
5547 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5548
5549 Example:
5550 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5551 if { status eq 404 }
5552
5553 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5554 string "This is the end !" \
5555 if { status eq 500 }
5556
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005557http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5558http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005560 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5561 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5562 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005563
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005564http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5565 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005566
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005567 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5568 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5569 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5570 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005572http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005573
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005574 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5575 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5576 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5577 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5578 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005579
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005580 Arguments:
5581 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005582
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005583 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5584 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005586http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005588 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5589 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5590 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005592http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5593
5594 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5595 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5596 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5597 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5598 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5599
5600http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5601
5602 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5603 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5604 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5605 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5606 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5607 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5608 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5609 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5610 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5611
5612http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5613
5614 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5615 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5616 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5617 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5618 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5619 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5620 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5621
5622http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5623
5624 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5625 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5626 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5627 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5628 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5629 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5630 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5631 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5632
5633http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5634 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5635
5636 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5637 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5638 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5639 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005640
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005641 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005642 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5643 http-response set-status 431
5644 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5645 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005647http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005649 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5650 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5651 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5652 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5653 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5654 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5655 based on some information from the request.
5656
5657 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5658
5659http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5660
5661 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5662 inline.
5663
5664 Arguments:
5665 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5666 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5669 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5670 (request and response)
5671 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5672 processing
5673 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5674 processing
5675 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5676 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5677 and '_'.
5678
5679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5680 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005681
5682 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005683 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005685http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005687 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5688 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5689 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5690 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5691 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5692 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5693 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5694 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5695 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5696 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5697 action.
5698 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5699 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5700 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5701 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5702 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005703
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005704http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5705
5706 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5707 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5708 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5709 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5710 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5711 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5712 processing.
5713
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005714 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005715 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5716 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5717 rules evaluation.
5718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005719http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5720http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5721http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005723 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5724 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5725 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5726 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5727 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5728 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5729
5730http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5731
5732 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5733 about <var-name>.
5734
5735 Example:
5736 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5737
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005738
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005739http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5740 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5741
5742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744
5745 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005746 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5747 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5748 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005749
5750 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5751
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005752 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5753 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5754 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5755 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5756 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5757 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5758 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5759 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5760 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5761 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005762
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005763 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5764 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5765 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5766 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5767 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5768 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5769 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5770 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005771
5772 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5773 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5774 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5775 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5776 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5777 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5778 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5779 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005780 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005781 downsides of rare connection failures.
5782
5783 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5784 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5785 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5786 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5787 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5788 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005789 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005790 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5791 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5792 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5793 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5794 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5795
5796 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005797 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5798 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5799 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005800
5801 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005802 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005803
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005804 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5805 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005806
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005807 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005808
5809 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5810 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5811 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5812
5813 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5814
5815
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005816http-send-name-header [<header>]
5817 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005820 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005821 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5822
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005823 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5824 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5825 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5826 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5827 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5828 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5829 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5830 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5831 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5832 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5833 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5834 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5835 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5836 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5837 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5838 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005839
5840 See also : "server"
5841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005842id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005843 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 no | yes | yes | yes
5846 Arguments : none
5847
5848 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5849 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5850 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005851
5852
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005853ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5854 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005856 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005857
5858 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5859 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5860 and running).
5861
5862 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5863 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5864 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005865 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005866 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5867
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005868 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5869 "unless" condition is met.
5870
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005871 Example:
5872 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5873 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5874 ignore-persist if url_static
5875
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005876 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5877
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005878load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5879 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 yes | no | yes | yes
5882
5883 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5884 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5885 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005886 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005887 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5888 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5889 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5890 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5891
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005892 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005893 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005894 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005895
5896 Arguments:
5897 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5898 named "server-state-file".
5899
5900 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5901 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5902 name is used as a file name.
5903
5904 none don't load any stat for this backend
5905
5906 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005907 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5908 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5909 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005910 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005911 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005912
5913 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5914 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5915
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005916 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005917
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005918 global
5919 stats socket /tmp/socket
5920 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005921
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005922 defaults
5923 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005924
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005925 backend bk
5926 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5927 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005928
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005929
5930 Then one can run :
5931
5932 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5933
5934 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5935
5936 1
5937 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5938 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5939 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5940
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005941 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005942
5943 global
5944 stats socket /tmp/socket
5945 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5946
5947 defaults
5948 load-server-state-from-file local
5949
5950 backend bk
5951 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5952 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5953
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005954
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005955 Then one can run :
5956
5957 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5958
5959 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5960
5961 1
5962 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5963 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5964 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5965
5966 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5967 "show servers state"
5968
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005970log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5972 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005973no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005974 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005977
5978 Prefix :
5979 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5980 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5981 prefix does not allow arguments.
5982
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005983 Arguments :
5984 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5985 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5986 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5987 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5988 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5989 parameter.
5990
5991 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5992 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5993
5994 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5995 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5996 standard syslog port).
5997
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005998 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5999 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6000 standard syslog port).
6001
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006002 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6003 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6004 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006005 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006006
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006007 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6008 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6009 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6010 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6011 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6012 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6013 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6014 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6015 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6016 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6017 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6018 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6019 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6020 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6021 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6022 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006023 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6024 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006025
6026 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6027 and "fd@2", see above.
6028
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006029 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6030 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6031 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6032 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6033 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6034 having the logs instantly available.
6035
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006036 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6037 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006038
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006039 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6040 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6041 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6042 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6043 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6044 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6045 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6046 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6047 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6048 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006049 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006050
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006051 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6052 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6053 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6054 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6055 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6056
6057 <sample_size>
6058 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6059 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6060 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6061 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6062 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6063
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006064 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6065 one of the following :
6066
6067 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6068 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6069
6070 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6071 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6072
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006073 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6074 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6075 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6076 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6077 systemd logger consumes.
6078
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006079 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6080 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6081 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6082 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6083
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006084 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6085
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006086 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6087 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6088 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6089
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006090 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6091 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6092 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6093 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006094
6095 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6096 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6097 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006098 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6099 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6100 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6101 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6102 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006103
6104 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6105
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006106 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6107 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6108 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006109
6110 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6111 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6112 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6113 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6114
6115 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6116 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006117
6118 Example :
6119 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006120 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6121 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6122 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006123 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6124 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006125 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006126
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006127
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006128log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006129 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6130 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6131 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006132
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006133 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6134 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6135 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6136 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6137 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006138
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006139 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6140 "option httplog" directives.
6141
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006142log-format-sd <string>
6143 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6145 yes | yes | yes | no
6146
6147 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6148 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6149 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6150 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6151 which covers the log format string in depth.
6152
6153 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6154 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6155
6156 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6157 log format to "rfc5424".
6158
6159 Example :
6160 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6161
6162
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006163log-tag <string>
6164 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 yes | yes | yes | yes
6167
6168 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6169 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6170 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6171 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6172 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6173 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6174 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6175 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6176 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006177
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006178max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6179 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | no | yes | yes
6182
6183 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6184 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6185 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6186 servers.
6187
6188 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6189 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6190 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6191 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6192 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006193 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006194 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6195 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6196 picking a different server.
6197
6198 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6199 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6200 even if they have to be queued.
6201
6202 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6203 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6204
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006205max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6206 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6207 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6208 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006210maxconn <conns>
6211 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 yes | yes | yes | no
6214 Arguments :
6215 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6216 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6217 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6218 closes.
6219
6220 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6221 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6222 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6223 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006224 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6225 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6226 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6227 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006228
6229 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6230 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6231 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6232
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006233 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6234 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006235
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006236 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6237
6238
6239mode { tcp|http|health }
6240 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 yes | yes | yes | yes
6243 Arguments :
6244 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6245 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6246 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6247 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6248
6249 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6250 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6251 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6252 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6253 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6254
6255 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006256 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6257 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6258 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6259 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6260 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6261 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6262 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006263
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006264 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6265 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6266 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006267
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006268 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006269 defaults http_instances
6270 mode http
6271
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006272 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006274
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006275monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006276 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6278 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006279 Arguments :
6280 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6281 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006282 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006283 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6284 backend and its backup.
6285
6286 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6287 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6288 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6289 servers in a list of backends.
6290
6291 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6292 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6293 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6294 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6295 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6296 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6297 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006298 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6299 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006300
6301 Example:
6302 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006303 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006304 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6305 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6306 monitor-uri /site_alive
6307 monitor fail if site_dead
6308
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006309 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006310
6311
6312monitor-net <source>
6313 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6315 yes | yes | yes | no
6316 Arguments :
6317 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6318 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6319 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6320 followed by a mask.
6321
6322 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6323 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006324 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006325 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6326
6327 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6328 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6329 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6330 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006331 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6332 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6333 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006334
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006335 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6336 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6337 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6338 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6339 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6340 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006341
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006342 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6343 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006344
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006345 Example :
6346 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6347 frontend www
6348 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6349
6350 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6351
6352
6353monitor-uri <uri>
6354 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 yes | yes | yes | no
6357 Arguments :
6358 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6359 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6360
6361 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6362 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6363 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6364 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6365 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6366 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6367 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6368 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6369
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006370 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006371 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6372 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6373 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6374 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6375 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6376 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006377
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006378 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6379 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6380 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6381 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6382
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006383 Example :
6384 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6385 frontend www
6386 mode http
6387 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6388
6389 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006391
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006392option abortonclose
6393no option abortonclose
6394 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6396 yes | no | yes | yes
6397 Arguments : none
6398
6399 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6400 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6401 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6402 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006403 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006404 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6405 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6406 encountered while delivering the response.
6407
6408 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6409 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6410 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6411 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6412 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6413 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006414 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006415 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006416 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006417 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6418 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6419 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6420
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006421 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6422 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006423 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6424 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6425 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6426 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6427 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6428 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006429 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006430
6431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6433
6434 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6435
6436
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006437option accept-invalid-http-request
6438no option accept-invalid-http-request
6439 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6441 yes | yes | yes | no
6442 Arguments : none
6443
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006444 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006445 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006446 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006447 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6448 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6449 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6450 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6451 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006452 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6453 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6454 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6455 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006456 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006457 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006458 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6459 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6460 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006461
6462 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6463 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6464 been confirmed.
6465
6466 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6467 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006468 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6469 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006470 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6471
6472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6474
6475 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6476 stats socket.
6477
6478
6479option accept-invalid-http-response
6480no option accept-invalid-http-response
6481 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | no | yes | yes
6484 Arguments : none
6485
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006486 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006487 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006488 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006489 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6490 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6491 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6492 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6493 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006494 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6495 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6496 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006497
6498 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6499 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6500 been confirmed.
6501
6502 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6503 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6504 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6505 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6506
6507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6509
6510 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6511 stats socket.
6512
6513
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006514option allbackups
6515no option allbackups
6516 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6518 yes | no | yes | yes
6519 Arguments : none
6520
6521 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6522 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6523 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6524 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6525 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6526 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6527 order between the backup servers anymore.
6528
6529 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6530 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6531
6532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6534
6535
6536option checkcache
6537no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006538 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6540 yes | no | yes | yes
6541 Arguments : none
6542
6543 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6544 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006545 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006546 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6547 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006548 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006549
6550 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006551 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006552 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006553 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6554 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006555 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006556 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006557 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6558 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006559 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006560 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6561 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006562 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006563 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6564 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6565 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6566 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6567 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6568 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6569 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6570 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6571 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6572
6573 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006574 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6575 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6576 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6577 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006578
6579 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6580 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006581 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006582 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006583
6584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6586
6587
6588option clitcpka
6589no option clitcpka
6590 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6592 yes | yes | yes | no
6593 Arguments : none
6594
6595 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6596 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006597 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006598 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6599
6600 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6601 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6602 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6603 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6604
6605 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6606 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6607 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6608 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6609 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6610
6611 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6612
6613 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6614 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6615 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6616
6617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6619
6620 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6621
6622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006623option contstats
6624 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6626 yes | yes | yes | no
6627 Arguments : none
6628
6629 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6630 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6631 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6632 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006633 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6634 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6635 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6636 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6637 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006638
6639
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006640option dontlog-normal
6641no option dontlog-normal
6642 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6644 yes | yes | yes | no
6645 Arguments : none
6646
6647 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6648 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6649 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6650 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6651 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6652 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6653 logged.
6654
6655 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6656 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6657 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006659 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006660 logging.
6661
6662
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006663option dontlognull
6664no option dontlognull
6665 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 yes | yes | yes | no
6668 Arguments : none
6669
6670 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6671 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6672 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6673 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6674 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6675 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006676 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6677 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6678 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006679
6680 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006681 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006682 would not be logged.
6683
6684 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6685 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6686
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006687 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6688 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006689
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006690
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006691option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006692 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | yes | yes | yes
6695 Arguments :
6696 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6697 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006698 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006699 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006700
6701 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6702 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6703 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6704 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6705 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6706 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6707 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006708 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6709 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6710 possible that the client has already brought one.
6711
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006712 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006713 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006714 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006715 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006716 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006717 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006718
6719 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6720 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6721 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6722 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6723 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6724 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6725 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6726
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006727 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6728 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6729 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6730 are under the control of the end-user.
6731
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006732 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006733 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6734 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006735 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6736 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6737 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006738
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006739 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006740 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6741 frontend www
6742 mode http
6743 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6744
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006745 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6746 backend www
6747 mode http
6748 option forwardfor header X-Client
6749
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006750 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006751 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006752
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006753
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006754option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6755no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6756 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6758 yes | yes | yes | no
6759 Arguments : none
6760
6761 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6762 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6763 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6764 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6765 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6766 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6767 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6768
6769 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6770 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6771 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6772 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6773 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6774 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6775 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6776 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6777 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6778 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6779
6780 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6781
6782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6784
6785 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6786 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6787
6788
6789option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6790no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6791 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | no | yes | yes
6794 Arguments : none
6795
6796 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6797 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6798 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6799 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6800 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6801 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6802 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6803
6804 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6805 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6806 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6807 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6808 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6809 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6810 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6811 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6812 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6813 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6814
6815 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6816
6817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6819
6820 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6821 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6822
6823
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006824option http-buffer-request
6825no option http-buffer-request
6826 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6828 yes | yes | yes | yes
6829 Arguments : none
6830
6831 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6832 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6833 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6834 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6835 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6836 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006837 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6838 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6839 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6840 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006841
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006842 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006843
6844
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006845option http-ignore-probes
6846no option http-ignore-probes
6847 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6849 yes | yes | yes | no
6850 Arguments : none
6851
6852 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6853 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6854 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6855 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6856 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6857 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6858 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6859 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6860 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006861 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6862 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006863 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6864
6865 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6866 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6867 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6868 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6869 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6870 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6871 are often the only way to detect them.
6872
6873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6875
6876 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6877
6878
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006879option http-keep-alive
6880no option http-keep-alive
6881 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | yes | yes | yes
6884 Arguments : none
6885
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006886 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6887 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006888 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6889 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006890 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6891 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6892 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006893
6894 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6895 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006896 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6897 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6898 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6899 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6900 situations where this option may be useful :
6901
6902 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006903 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006904
6905 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6906 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6907
6908 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6909 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6910 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6911 request.
6912
6913 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6914 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006915 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6916 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6917 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006918
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006919 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6920 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6921 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6922 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6923 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6924 not set.
6925
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006926 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6927 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6928 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006929
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006930 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006931 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006932 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006933
6934
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006935option http-no-delay
6936no option http-no-delay
6937 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6939 yes | yes | yes | yes
6940 Arguments : none
6941
6942 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6943 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6944 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6945 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6946 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6947 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6948 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6949 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6950 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6951 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6952 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6953 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6954 affected.
6955
6956 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6957 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6958 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6959 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6960 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6961 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6962 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6963 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6964 latency environments.
6965
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006966 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6967
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006968
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006969option http-pretend-keepalive
6970no option http-pretend-keepalive
6971 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006973 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006974 Arguments : none
6975
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006976 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006977 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6978 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6979 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6980 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6981 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6982 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6983 consider the response complete.
6984
6985 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6986 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6987 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6988 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006989 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006990 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6991
6992 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6993 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6994 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6995 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6996 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6997 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6998 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6999
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007000 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7001 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7002 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7003 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7004 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7005 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007006
7007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7009
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007010 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007011 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007012
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007013
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007014option http-server-close
7015no option http-server-close
7016 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7018 yes | yes | yes | yes
7019 Arguments : none
7020
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007021 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7022 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7023 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7024 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007025 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7026 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7027 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7028 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7029 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7030 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7031 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7032 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7033 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7034 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7035 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007036
7037 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7038 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7039 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7040 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007041 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7042 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007043
7044 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7045 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007046 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7047 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7048 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007049
7050 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7051 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7052
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007053 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7054 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007055
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007056option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007057no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007058 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 yes | yes | yes | no
7061 Arguments : none
7062
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007063 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007064 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7065 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7066 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7067 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7068 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7069 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7070
7071 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7072 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007073 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7074 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7075 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007076
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007077 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7078 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7079 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7080 front of an existing proxy.
7081
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007082 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7083
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007084 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007086option httpchk
7087option httpchk <uri>
7088option httpchk <method> <uri>
7089option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7090 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7092 yes | no | yes | yes
7093 Arguments :
7094 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7095 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7096 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7097 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7098 ones.
7099
7100 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7101 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7102 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7103
7104 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7105 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7106 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7107 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7108 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7109
7110 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7111 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7112 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7113 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7114 the lack of any response.
7115
7116 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7117
7118 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7119 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7120 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7121
7122 Examples :
7123 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7124 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7125 backend https_relay
7126 mode tcp
7127 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7128 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7129
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007130 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7131 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7132 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007133
7134
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007135option httpclose
7136no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007137 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7139 yes | yes | yes | yes
7140 Arguments : none
7141
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007142 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7143 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7144 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7145 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007146 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007147
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007148 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7149 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007150 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007151 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7152 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007153
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007154 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7155 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7156 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007157
7158 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7159 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007160 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7161 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7162 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007163
7164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7166
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007167 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007168
7169
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007170option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007171 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007173 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007174 Arguments :
7175 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7176 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7177 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007178 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007179 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007180
7181 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7182 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7183 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7184 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7185 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7186 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7187 ports.
7188
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007189 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7190 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007191
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007192 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007194 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007196
7197option http_proxy
7198no option http_proxy
7199 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7201 yes | yes | yes | yes
7202 Arguments : none
7203
7204 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7205 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7206 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7207 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7208 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7209
7210 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7211 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007212 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7213 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007214
7215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7217
7218 Example :
7219 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7220 backend direct_forward
7221 option httpclose
7222 option http_proxy
7223
7224 See also : "option httpclose"
7225
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007226
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007227option independent-streams
7228no option independent-streams
7229 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 yes | yes | yes | yes
7232 Arguments : none
7233
7234 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7235 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7236 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7237 receive data or not.
7238
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007239 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007240 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7241 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7242 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7243 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7244 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7245 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7246 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7247 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7248 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7249 socket buffers.
7250
7251 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7252 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7253 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7254 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7255 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7256
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007257 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007258
7259
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007260option ldap-check
7261 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7263 yes | no | yes | yes
7264 Arguments : none
7265
7266 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7267 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7268 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7269 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7270
7271 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7272 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7273
7274 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7275 configure it.
7276
7277 Example :
7278 option ldap-check
7279
7280 See also : "option httpchk"
7281
7282
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007283option external-check
7284 Use external processes for server health checks
7285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7286 yes | no | yes | yes
7287
7288 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7289 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7290 command".
7291
7292 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7293
7294 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7295
7296
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007297option log-health-checks
7298no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007299 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 yes | no | yes | yes
7302 Arguments : none
7303
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007304 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7305 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7306 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007307
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007308 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7309 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7310 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7311 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7312 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7313
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007314 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007315 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007316
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007317 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7318 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7319 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007320
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007321
7322option log-separate-errors
7323no option log-separate-errors
7324 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | yes | yes | no
7327 Arguments : none
7328
7329 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7330 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7331 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7332 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7333 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7334 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7335 provides very important information.
7336
7337 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7338 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7339 error logs.
7340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007341 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007342 logging.
7343
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007344
7345option logasap
7346no option logasap
7347 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7349 yes | yes | yes | no
7350 Arguments : none
7351
7352 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7353 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7354 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7355 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7356 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7357 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7358 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007359 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007360 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7361 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7362
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007363 Examples :
7364 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7365 mode http
7366 option httplog
7367 option logasap
7368 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7369
7370 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7371 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7372 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7373 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007375 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007376 logging.
7377
7378
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007379option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007380 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7382 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007383 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007384 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7385 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007386 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007387
7388 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7389 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007390 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007391 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7392 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7393 in the MySQL table, like this :
7394
7395 USE mysql;
7396 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7397 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7398
7399 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007400 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007401 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7402 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7403 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7404 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7405 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7406 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7407 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7408
7409 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7410 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007411
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007412 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007413
7414 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7415 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7416 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7417 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007418 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7419 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007420
7421 See also: "option httpchk"
7422
7423
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007424option nolinger
7425no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007426 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7428 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007429 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007431 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007432 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7433 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7434 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7435 connections.
7436
7437 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7438 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7439 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7440 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7441 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7442 this too.
7443
7444 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7445 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7446 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7447
7448 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7449 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7450 for servers.
7451
7452 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7453 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7454
7455
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007456option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7457 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 yes | yes | yes | yes
7460 Arguments :
7461 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7462 matching <network>
7463 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7464 header name.
7465
7466 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7467 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7468 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7469 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7470 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7471 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7472 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7473 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7474 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7475 possible that the client has already brought one.
7476
7477 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7478 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7479 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7480 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7481 header and requires different one.
7482
7483 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7484 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7485 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7486 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7487 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7488 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7489 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7490
7491 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7492 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7493 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7494 both are defined.
7495
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007496 Examples :
7497 # Original Destination address
7498 frontend www
7499 mode http
7500 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7501
7502 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7503 backend www
7504 mode http
7505 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7506
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007507 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007508
7509
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007510option persist
7511no option persist
7512 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007515 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007516
7517 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7518 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7519 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7520 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7521 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7522 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7523 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7524 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7525 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7526 redirected to another valid server.
7527
7528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7530
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007531 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007532
7533
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007534option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7535 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7537 yes | no | yes | yes
7538 Arguments :
7539 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7540 PostgreSQL server.
7541
7542 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7543 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7544 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7545 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7546
7547 See also: "option httpchk"
7548
7549
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007550option prefer-last-server
7551no option prefer-last-server
7552 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7553 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7554 yes | no | yes | yes
7555 Arguments : none
7556
7557 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7558 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7559 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7560 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7561 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7562 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7563 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7564 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7565 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007566 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7567 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007568 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7569 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7570 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007571 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7572 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7573 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007574
7575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7577
7578 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7579
7580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007581option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007582option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007583no option redispatch
7584 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7586 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007587 Arguments :
7588 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7589 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7590 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007591 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007592 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007594 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7595 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7596 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007598
7599 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7600 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7601 be able to access the service anymore.
7602
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007603 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7604 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007605
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007606 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007607 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7608 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7612
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007613 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007614
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007615
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007616option redis-check
7617 Use redis health checks for server testing
7618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7619 yes | no | yes | yes
7620 Arguments : none
7621
7622 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7623 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7624 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7625 find the "+PONG" response message.
7626
7627 Example :
7628 option redis-check
7629
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007630 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007631
7632
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007633option smtpchk
7634option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7635 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7637 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007638 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007639 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007640 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007641 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7642
7643 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7644 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7645 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7646
7647 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7648 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7649 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7650 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7651 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7652 dead server.
7653
7654 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7655 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007656 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007657 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7658
7659 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7660 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7661 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7662 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007663 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007664
7665 Example :
7666 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7667
7668 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007671option socket-stats
7672no option socket-stats
7673
7674 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 yes | yes | yes | no
7677
7678 Arguments : none
7679
7680
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007681option splice-auto
7682no option splice-auto
7683 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7685 yes | yes | yes | yes
7686 Arguments : none
7687
7688 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7689 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007690 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007691 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007692 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007693 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7694 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7695 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7696 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7697
7698 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7699 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7700 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7701 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7702 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7703 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7704 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7705 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7706 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7707 keyword.
7708
7709 Example :
7710 option splice-auto
7711
7712 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7713 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7714
7715 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7716 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7717
7718
7719option splice-request
7720no option splice-request
7721 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7723 yes | yes | yes | yes
7724 Arguments : none
7725
7726 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007727 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007728 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7729 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7730 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7731 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7732
7733 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7734
7735 Example :
7736 option splice-request
7737
7738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7740
7741 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7742 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7743
7744
7745option splice-response
7746no option splice-response
7747 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7749 yes | yes | yes | yes
7750 Arguments : none
7751
7752 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007753 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007754 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7755 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7756 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7757 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7758
7759 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7760
7761 Example :
7762 option splice-response
7763
7764 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7765 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7766
7767 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7768 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7769
7770
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007771option spop-check
7772 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 no | no | no | yes
7775 Arguments : none
7776
7777 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7778 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7779 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7780 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7781
7782 Example :
7783 option spop-check
7784
7785 See also : "option httpchk"
7786
7787
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007788option srvtcpka
7789no option srvtcpka
7790 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7792 yes | no | yes | yes
7793 Arguments : none
7794
7795 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7796 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007797 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007798 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7799
7800 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7801 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7802 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7803 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7804
7805 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7806 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7807 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7808 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7809 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7810
7811 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7812
7813 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7814 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7815 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7816
7817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7819
7820 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7821
7822
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007823option ssl-hello-chk
7824 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7826 yes | no | yes | yes
7827 Arguments : none
7828
7829 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7830 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7831 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7832 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7833 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7834 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7835 hello message.
7836
7837 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7838 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7839 messages, which is appreciable.
7840
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007841 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7842 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7843 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007844
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007845 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7846
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007847
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007848option tcp-check
7849 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7851 yes | no | yes | yes
7852
7853 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7854 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7855
7856 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7857 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7858 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7859
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007860 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007861 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7862 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7863 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7864 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7865 only.
7866
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007867 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007868 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7869 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7870 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7871 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7872
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007873 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007874 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7875 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007876 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007877 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7878 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7879 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7880 the respective protocols.
7881 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007882 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007883
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007884 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7885 script.
7886
7887 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7888 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7889 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7890 The "comment" is of course optional.
7891
7892
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007893 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007894 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007895 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007896 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007898 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007899 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007900 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007901
7902 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7903 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007904 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007905 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007906 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007907 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007908 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007909 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007910 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7911 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007912 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007913 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7914 tcp-check expect string +OK
7915
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007916 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007917 (send many headers before analyzing)
7918 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007919 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007920 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7921 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7922 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7923 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007924 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007925
7926
7927 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7928
7929
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007930option tcp-smart-accept
7931no option tcp-smart-accept
7932 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7934 yes | yes | yes | no
7935 Arguments : none
7936
7937 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7938 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7939 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7940 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7941 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7942 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7943
7944 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7945 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7946 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7947 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7948
7949 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7950 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7951 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007952 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007953
7954 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7955 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7956 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7957
7958 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7959 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7960 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7961
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007962 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7963
7964
7965option tcp-smart-connect
7966no option tcp-smart-connect
7967 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7969 yes | no | yes | yes
7970 Arguments : none
7971
7972 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7973 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7974 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7975 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7976 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7977
7978 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7979 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7980 complex.
7981
7982 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7983 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7984 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7985
7986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7988
7989 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7990
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007991
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007992option tcpka
7993 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 yes | yes | yes | yes
7996 Arguments : none
7997
7998 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7999 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008000 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008001 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8002
8003 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8004 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8005 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8006 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8007
8008 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8009 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8010 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8011 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8012 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8013
8014 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8015
8016 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8017 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8018 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8019 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8020 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8021 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8022 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8023 backends.
8024
8025 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8026
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008027
8028option tcplog
8029 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008031 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008032 Arguments : none
8033
8034 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8035 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8036 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8037 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8038 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8039 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8040 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8041 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8042
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008043 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008045 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008046
8047
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008048option transparent
8049no option transparent
8050 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008052 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008053 Arguments : none
8054
8055 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8056 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8057 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8058 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8059 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8060 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8061 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8062 appropriate server.
8063
8064 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8065 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8066
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008067 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008068 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008069
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008070
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008071external-check command <command>
8072 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8074 yes | no | yes | yes
8075
8076 Arguments :
8077 <command> is the external command to run
8078
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008079 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8080
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008081 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008082
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008083 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8084 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8085 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8086 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8087 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8088 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008089
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008090 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8091
8092 Environment variables :
8093 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8094 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8095
8096 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8097
8098 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8099
8100 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8101 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8102 for a UNIX socket).
8103
8104 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8105
8106 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8107
8108 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8109
8110 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8111
8112 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8113
8114 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8115 socket).
8116
8117 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8118 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8119
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008120 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8121
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008122 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8123 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8124 failed.
8125
8126 Example :
8127 external-check command /bin/true
8128
8129 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8130
8131
8132external-check path <path>
8133 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8135 yes | no | yes | yes
8136
8137 Arguments :
8138 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8139
8140 The default path is "".
8141
8142 Example :
8143 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8144
8145 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8146 "external-check command"
8147
8148
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008149persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008150persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008151 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8153 yes | no | yes | yes
8154 Arguments :
8155 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008156 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8157 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008158
8159 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8160 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008161 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008162 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8163 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8164 forwarded to this server.
8165
8166 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8167 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8168 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008169 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008170 a single "listen" section.
8171
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008172 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8173 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8174 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8175
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008176 Example :
8177 listen tse-farm
8178 bind :3389
8179 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8180 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8181 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8182 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8183 persist rdp-cookie
8184 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008185 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008186 balance rdp-cookie
8187 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8188 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8189
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008190 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8191 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008192
8193
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008194rate-limit sessions <rate>
8195 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8197 yes | yes | yes | no
8198 Arguments :
8199 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8200 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8201
8202 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8203 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8204 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8205 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8206 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8207 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8208
8209 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8210 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8211 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8212 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8213
8214 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8215 listen smtp
8216 mode tcp
8217 bind :25
8218 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008219 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008220
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008221 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8222 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8223 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008224
8225 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8226
8227
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008228redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8229redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8230redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008231 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8233 no | yes | yes | yes
8234
8235 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008236 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008237
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008238 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008239 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008240 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8241 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8242 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008243
8244 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8245 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8246 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8247 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8248 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008249 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8250 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8251 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8252 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008253
8254 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8255 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8256 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8257 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8258 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8259 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008260 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008261 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008262 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8263 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8264 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008265
8266 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008267 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8268 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8269 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008270 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008271 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8272 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8273 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8274 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008275
8276 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008277 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008278
8279 - "drop-query"
8280 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8281 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8282 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8283 with a location-type redirect.
8284
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008285 - "append-slash"
8286 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8287 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8288 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8289 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8290
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008291 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8292 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8293 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8294 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8295 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8296 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8297 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8298
8299 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8300 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8301 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8302 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8303 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8304 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8305 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008306
8307 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8308 acl clear dst_port 80
8309 acl secure dst_port 8080
8310 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008311 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008312 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008313 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8314
8315 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008316 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8317 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8318 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008319 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008320
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008321 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8322 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8323 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8324
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008325 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008326 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008327
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008328 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008329 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8330 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8331 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008333 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008334
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008335
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008336retries <value>
8337 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8338 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8339 yes | no | yes | yes
8340 Arguments :
8341 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8342 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8343 default value is 3.
8344
8345 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8346 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8347 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8348
8349 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008350 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8351 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008352
8353 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8354 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8355
8356 See also : "option redispatch"
8357
8358
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008359retry-on [list of keywords]
8360 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8362 yes | no | yes | yes
8363 Arguments :
8364 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8365 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8366 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8367 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8368
8369 none never retry
8370
8371 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8372 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8373
8374 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8375 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8376 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8377 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8378 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8379 processing the request.
8380
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008381 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8382 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8383 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8384 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8385 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8386 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8387 overflow attack for example).
8388
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008389 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8390 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8391 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8392 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8393 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8394 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8395 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8396 amplify denial of service attacks.
8397
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008398 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8399 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8400 considered to be safe to retry.
8401
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008402 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8403 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8404 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8405 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8406
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008407 all-retryable-errors
8408 retry request for any error that are considered
8409 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8410 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8411 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8412
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008413 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8414 not cumulative.
8415
8416 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8417 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8418 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8419 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8420
8421 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8422 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8423 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8424 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8425 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8426 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8427 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8428 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8429 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8430 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8431 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8432 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8433
8434 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8435 should not use this directive.
8436
8437 The default is "conn-failure".
8438
8439 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8440
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008441server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008442 Declare a server in a backend
8443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8444 no | no | yes | yes
8445 Arguments :
8446 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008447 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008448 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008449
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008450 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8451 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8452 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8453 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008454 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8455 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8456 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8457 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8458 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008459 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8460 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8461 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8462 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8463 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8464 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8465 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008466 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008467 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8468 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8469 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8470 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8471 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8472 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008473 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8474 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008475 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8476 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008477
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008478 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008479 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8480 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8481 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8482 adding this value to the client's port.
8483
8484 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8485 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008486 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008487
8488 Examples :
8489 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8490 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008491 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008492 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8493 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8494 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008495
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008496 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8497 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8498 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8499 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8500 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8501
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008502 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8503 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008504
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008505server-state-file-name [<file>]
8506 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8507 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8508 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8509 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8510 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8511 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8512
8513 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8514 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8515
8516 global
8517 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8518
8519 backend bk
8520 load-server-state-from-file
8521
8522 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8523 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008524
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008525server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8526 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8527 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8529 no | no | yes | yes
8530
8531 Arguments:
8532 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8533
8534 <num | range>
8535 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8536 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8537 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8538 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8539
8540 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8541
8542 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8543
8544 <params*>
8545 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8546 keyword.
8547
8548 Examples:
8549 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8550 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8551 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8552
8553 # or
8554 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8555
8556 # would be equivalent to:
8557 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8558 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8559 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8560
8561
8562
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008563source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008564source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008565source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008566 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8568 yes | no | yes | yes
8569 Arguments :
8570 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8571 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008572
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008573 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008574 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8575 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8576 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8577 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8578 supported prefixes are :
8579 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8580 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8581 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008582 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008583 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8584 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008585
8586 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8587 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008588 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8589 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8590 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591
8592 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8593 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8594 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8595 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8596 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8597 <addr>.
8598
8599 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8600 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8601 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8602 port.
8603
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008604 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8605 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8606 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8607 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008608 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008609 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8610 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8611 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8612 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8613 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8614 HTTP header.
8615
8616 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8617 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008618 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008619 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8620 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8621 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8622 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8623 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8624 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8625 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8626
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008627 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8628 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8629 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8630 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8631 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8632 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8633
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008634 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8635 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8636 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8637 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8638
8639 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8640 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8641 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8642 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8643 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8644 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8645
8646 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8647 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8648 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8649 there are two methods :
8650
8651 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8652 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8653 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8654 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8655 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8656 of the client ranges may be used.
8657
8658 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8659 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8660 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8661 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8662 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8663 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8664 same session.
8665
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8667 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8668 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008671 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8672
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008673 Examples :
8674 backend private
8675 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8676 source 192.168.1.200
8677
8678 backend transparent_ssl1
8679 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8680 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8681
8682 backend transparent_ssl2
8683 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8684 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8685 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8686
8687 backend transparent_ssl3
8688 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8689 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8690 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8691
8692 backend transparent_smtp
8693 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8694 # with Tproxy version 4.
8695 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8696
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008697 backend transparent_http
8698 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8699 # proxy.
8700 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008702 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8704
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008705
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008706stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8707 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008709 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008710
8711 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8712 matched.
8713
8714 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8715 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008717 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8718 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008720
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008721 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8722 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8723 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8724 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008725
8726 Example :
8727 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8728 backend stats_localhost
8729 stats enable
8730 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8731
8732 Example :
8733 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8734 backend stats_auth
8735 stats enable
8736 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8737 stats admin if TRUE
8738
8739 Example :
8740 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8741 userlist stats-auth
8742 group admin users admin
8743 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8744 group readonly users haproxy
8745 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8746
8747 backend stats_auth
8748 stats enable
8749 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8750 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8751 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8752 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8753
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008754 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8755 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8756 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008757
8758
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008759stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8760 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008762 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008763 Arguments :
8764 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8765
8766 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8767
8768 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8769 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8770 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8771 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8772 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8773 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8774
8775 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8776 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8777 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008778 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008779
8780 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8781 report using "stats scope".
8782
8783 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8784 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8785 unobvious parameters.
8786
8787 Example :
8788 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8789 backend public_www
8790 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8791 stats enable
8792 stats hide-version
8793 stats scope .
8794 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008795 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008796 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8797 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8798
8799 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8800 backend private_monitoring
8801 stats enable
8802 stats uri /admin?stats
8803 stats refresh 5s
8804
8805 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8806
8807
8808stats enable
8809 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008811 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008812 Arguments : none
8813
8814 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8815 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8816 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8817 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8818 - stats auth : no authentication
8819 - stats scope : no restriction
8820
8821 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8822 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8823 unobvious parameters.
8824
8825 Example :
8826 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8827 backend public_www
8828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8829 stats enable
8830 stats hide-version
8831 stats scope .
8832 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008833 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008834 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8835 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8836
8837 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8838 backend private_monitoring
8839 stats enable
8840 stats uri /admin?stats
8841 stats refresh 5s
8842
8843 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8844
8845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008846stats hide-version
8847 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008850 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008851
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008852 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8853 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8854 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8855 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8856 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8857 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008859 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8860 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8861 unobvious parameters.
8862
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008863 Example :
8864 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8865 backend public_www
8866 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008867 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868 stats hide-version
8869 stats scope .
8870 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008872 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8873 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008874
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008875 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8876 backend private_monitoring
8877 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008878 stats uri /admin?stats
8879 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008880
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008881 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008882
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008883
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008884stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8885 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8886 Access control for statistics
8887
8888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8889 no | no | yes | yes
8890
8891 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8892 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8893 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8894 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8895 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8896 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8897
8898 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8899 instance.
8900
8901 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8902 about ACL usage.
8903
8904
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008905stats realm <realm>
8906 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008908 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008909 Arguments :
8910 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8911 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8912 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8913
8914 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8915 using a backslash ('\').
8916
8917 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8918 only related to authentication.
8919
8920 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8921 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8922 unobvious parameters.
8923
8924 Example :
8925 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8926 backend public_www
8927 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8928 stats enable
8929 stats hide-version
8930 stats scope .
8931 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008932 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008933 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8934 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8935
8936 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8937 backend private_monitoring
8938 stats enable
8939 stats uri /admin?stats
8940 stats refresh 5s
8941
8942 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8943
8944
8945stats refresh <delay>
8946 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008948 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008949 Arguments :
8950 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8951 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8952 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8953 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8954 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8955 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8956
8957 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8958 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8959 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8960 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8961
8962 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8963 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8964 unobvious parameters.
8965
8966 Example :
8967 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8968 backend public_www
8969 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8970 stats enable
8971 stats hide-version
8972 stats scope .
8973 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008974 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008975 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8976 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8977
8978 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8979 backend private_monitoring
8980 stats enable
8981 stats uri /admin?stats
8982 stats refresh 5s
8983
8984 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8985
8986
8987stats scope { <name> | "." }
8988 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008990 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008991 Arguments :
8992 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8993 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8994 section in which the statement appears.
8995
8996 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8997 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8998 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8999 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9000 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9001 exists.
9002
9003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9005 unobvious parameters.
9006
9007 Example :
9008 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9009 backend public_www
9010 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9011 stats enable
9012 stats hide-version
9013 stats scope .
9014 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009016 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9017 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9018
9019 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9020 backend private_monitoring
9021 stats enable
9022 stats uri /admin?stats
9023 stats refresh 5s
9024
9025 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9026
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009027
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009028stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009029 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009031 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009033 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009034 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9035
9036 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9037 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9038
9039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009041 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009042
9043 Example :
9044 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9045 backend private_monitoring
9046 stats enable
9047 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9048 stats uri /admin?stats
9049 stats refresh 5s
9050
9051 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9052 global section.
9053
9054
9055stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009056 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9058 yes | yes | yes | yes
9059 Arguments : none
9060
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009061 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009062 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9063 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9064 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9065 - IP (socket, server)
9066 - cookie (backend, server)
9067
9068 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9069 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009070 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009071
9072 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9073
9074
9075stats show-node [ <name> ]
9076 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009078 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009079 Arguments:
9080 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9081 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9082
9083 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9084 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009085 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009086
9087 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9088 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9089 unobvious parameters.
9090
9091 Example:
9092 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9093 backend private_monitoring
9094 stats enable
9095 stats show-node Europe-1
9096 stats uri /admin?stats
9097 stats refresh 5s
9098
9099 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9100 section.
9101
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009102
9103stats uri <prefix>
9104 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009106 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009107 Arguments :
9108 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9109 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9110 query string.
9111
9112 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9113 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9114 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9115 possible to reach it in the application.
9116
9117 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009118 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009119 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9120 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9121 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9122 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9123
9124 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9125 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9126 an address or a port to statistics only.
9127
9128 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9129 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9130 unobvious parameters.
9131
9132 Example :
9133 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9134 backend public_www
9135 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9136 stats enable
9137 stats hide-version
9138 stats scope .
9139 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009140 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009141 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9142 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9143
9144 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9145 backend private_monitoring
9146 stats enable
9147 stats uri /admin?stats
9148 stats refresh 5s
9149
9150 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9151
9152
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009153stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9154 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009156 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009157
9158 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009159 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009160 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009161 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009162 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9163
9164 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9165 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9166 the "stick-table" statement.
9167
9168 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9169 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9170 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9171 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9172 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9173
9174 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9175 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9176 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9177 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9178 transformation rules.
9179
9180 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9181 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9182 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9183 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9184 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9185 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9186 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9187
9188 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9189 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9190 ACL based conditions.
9191
9192 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9193 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9194 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9195 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9196
9197 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9198 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9199 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9200 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9201
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009202 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9203 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009204 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009205
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009206 Example :
9207 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9208 # last 30 minutes
9209 backend pop
9210 mode tcp
9211 balance roundrobin
9212 stick store-request src
9213 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9214 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9215 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9216
9217 backend smtp
9218 mode tcp
9219 balance roundrobin
9220 stick match src table pop
9221 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9222 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9223
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009224 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009225 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009226
9227
9228stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9229 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9231 no | no | yes | yes
9232
9233 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9234 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9235 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9236 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9237
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009238 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9239 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009240 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009241
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009242 Examples :
9243 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009244 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009245
9246 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9247 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9248 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9249
9250
9251 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9252 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9253 backend http
9254 mode http
9255 balance roundrobin
9256 stick on src table https
9257 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9258 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9259 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9260
9261 backend https
9262 mode tcp
9263 balance roundrobin
9264 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9265 stick on src
9266 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9267 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9268
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009269 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009270
9271
9272stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9273 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9275 no | no | yes | yes
9276
9277 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009278 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009279 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009280 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009281 server is selected.
9282
9283 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9284 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9285 the "stick-table" statement.
9286
9287 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9288 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9289 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9290 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9291 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9292 address.
9293
9294 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9295 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9296 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9297 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9298 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9299 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9300 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9301 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9302 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9303 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9304
9305 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9306 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9307 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9308 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9309 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9310 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9311 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9312
9313 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9314 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9315 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9316 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9317
9318 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9319 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9320 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9321 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9322 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9323 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009324 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9325 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9326 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9327 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9328 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9329 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009330
9331 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9332 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9333 the request.
9334
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009335 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9336 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009337 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009338
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009339 Example :
9340 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9341 # last 30 minutes
9342 backend pop
9343 mode tcp
9344 balance roundrobin
9345 stick store-request src
9346 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9347 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9348 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9349
9350 backend smtp
9351 mode tcp
9352 balance roundrobin
9353 stick match src table pop
9354 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9355 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9356
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009357 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009358 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009359
9360
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009361stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009362 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9363 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009364 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009366 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009367
9368 Arguments :
9369 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9370 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9371 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9372 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9373
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009374 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9375 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9376 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9377 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9378
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009379 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9380 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9381 instance.
9382
9383 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9384 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9385 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9386 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9387 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9388 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009389 to 32 characters.
9390
9391 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9392 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9393 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009394 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009395 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9396 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009397
9398 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009399 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9400 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009401 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9402 increase.
9403
9404 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009405 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9406 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9407 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009408
9409 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9410 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9411 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9412 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009413 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009414 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9415 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9416 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9417 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9418 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9419 parameter (see below).
9420
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009421 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9422 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9423 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9424 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9425 soft restart.
9426
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009427 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9428 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009429
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009430 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9431 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9432 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9433 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009434 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009435 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009436 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9437 if not expiration delay is specified.
9438
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009439 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9440 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9441 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9442 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009443 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9444 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9445 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9446 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9447 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9448 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9449 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9450 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9451 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9452 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9453 types and their arguments.
9454
9455 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9456 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9457 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9458 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9459
9460 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9461 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9462 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009463 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009464
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009465 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9466 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9467 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009468 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009469 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009470 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009471
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009472 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9473 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9474 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9475 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9476
9477 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9478 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9479 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9480 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9481 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9482 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9483
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009484 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9485 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9486 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9487 they were received.
9488
9489 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9490 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9491 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9492 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9493 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9494
9495 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9496 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9497 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9498 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9499 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9500
9501 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9502 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9503 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9504
9505 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9506 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9507 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9508 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9509 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9510
9511 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9512 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9513 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9514 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9515 the client side.
9516
9517 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9518 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9519 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9520 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9521 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9522 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9523 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9524
9525 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9526 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9527 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9528 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9529 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9530 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009531 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009532
9533 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9534 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9535 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9536 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9537 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9538 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9539
9540 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009541 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009542 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9543 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9544
9545 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9546 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9547 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9548 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9549 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9550 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9551 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9552 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9553 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9554 recommended for better fairness.
9555
9556 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009557 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009558 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9559 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9560
9561 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9562 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9563 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9564 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9565 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9566 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9567 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9568 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9569 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9570 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009571
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009572 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9573 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009574 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9575 reference it.
9576
9577 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9578 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009579 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9580 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9581 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009582
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009583 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9584 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9585 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9586 something that can be ignored.
9587
9588 Example:
9589 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9590 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9591 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9592 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9593
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009594 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009595 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009596
9597
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009598stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009599 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9601 no | no | yes | yes
9602
9603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009604 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009605 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009607 server is selected.
9608
9609 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9610 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9611 the "stick-table" statement.
9612
9613 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9614 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9615 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9616 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9617
9618 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9619 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9620 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9621 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9622 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9623 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009624 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009625 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9626 rules.
9627
9628 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9629 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9630 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9631 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9632 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9633 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9634 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9635
9636 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9637 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9638 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9639 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9640
9641 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9642 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9643 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9644 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9645 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9646 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009647 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9648 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9649 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9650 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9651 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9652 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9653 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9654 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9655 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009656
9657 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9658
9659 Example :
9660 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9661 backend https
9662 mode tcp
9663 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009664 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009665 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009666
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009667 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9668 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9669
9670 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9671 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9672 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9673
9674 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9675 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009676
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009677 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9678 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9679 # at offset 44.
9680
9681 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9682 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9683
9684 # Learn on response if server hello.
9685 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009686
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009687 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9688 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9689
9690 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9691 extraction.
9692
9693
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009694tcp-check connect [params*]
9695 Opens a new connection
9696 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9697 no | no | yes | yes
9698
9699 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9700 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9701 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9702
9703 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9704 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9705 of the sequence.
9706
9707 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9708 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9709 do.
9710
9711 Parameters :
9712 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9713 use the TCP connection.
9714
9715 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9716 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9717 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9718
9719 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9720
9721 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9722
9723 Examples:
9724 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9725 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9726 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9727 option tcp-check
9728 tcp-check connect
9729 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9730 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9731 tcp-check send \r\n
9732 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9733 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9734 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9735 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9736 tcp-check send \r\n
9737 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9738 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9739
9740 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9741 option tcp-check
9742 tcp-check connect port 110
9743 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9744 tcp-check connect port 143
9745 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9746 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9747
9748 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9749
9750
9751tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009752 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009753 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9754 no | no | yes | yes
9755
9756 Arguments :
9757 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9758 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9759 binary.
9760 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9761 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9762 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9763
9764 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9765 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9766 with the usual backslash ('\').
9767 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009768 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009769 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9770 used upper or lower case.
9771
9772
9773 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9774
9775 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9776 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9777 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9778 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9779 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9780 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9781 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9782 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9783
9784 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9785 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9786 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9787 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9788 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9789 expression.
9790
9791 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9792 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9793 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9794 this exact hexadecimal string.
9795 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9796
9797 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9798 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9799 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9800 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9801 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9802 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9803 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9804 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9805 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9806 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9807 the null character.
9808
9809 Examples :
9810 # perform a POP check
9811 option tcp-check
9812 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9813
9814 # perform an IMAP check
9815 option tcp-check
9816 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9817
9818 # look for the redis master server
9819 option tcp-check
9820 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009821 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009822 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9823 tcp-check expect string role:master
9824 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9825 tcp-check expect string +OK
9826
9827
9828 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9829 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9830
9831
9832tcp-check send <data>
9833 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9835 no | no | yes | yes
9836
9837 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9838 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9839
9840 Examples :
9841 # look for the redis master server
9842 option tcp-check
9843 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9844 tcp-check expect string role:master
9845
9846 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9847 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9848
9849
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009850tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9851 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009852 tcp health check
9853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9854 no | no | yes | yes
9855
9856 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9857 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009858 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009859 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9860 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9861 hexadecimal string.
9862 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9863
9864 Examples :
9865 # redis check in binary
9866 option tcp-check
9867 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9868 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9869
9870
9871 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9872 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9873
9874
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9876 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9878 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009879 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009880 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9881 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009883 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009884
9885 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9886 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009887 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9888 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9889 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9890 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9891 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9892 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009893
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009894 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9895 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9896 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9897 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009898
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009899 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009900 - accept :
9901 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9902 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9903 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009905 - reject :
9906 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9907 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9908 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9909 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9910 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9911 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9912 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9913 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9914 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9915 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9916 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009917 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009918
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009919 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9920 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9921 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9922 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9923 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9924 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9925 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9926 hosts.
9927
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009928 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9929 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9930 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9931 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9932 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9933 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9934 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9935 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9936
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009937 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9938 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9939 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9940 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9941 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9942 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9943 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9944 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9945 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009946 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9947 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009948
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009949 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009950 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009951 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9952 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9953 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009954 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009955 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9956 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9957 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9958 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9959 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9960 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9961 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9962 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009965 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009966 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009967 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009968 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9969 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9970 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009972 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9973 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9974 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9975 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009977 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9978 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9979 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9980 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9981 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009982 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9983 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9984 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9985 layer7 information is extracted.
9986
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009987 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9988 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9989 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9990 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9991 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009992
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009993 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9994 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9995 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9996 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9997
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009998 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9999 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10000 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10001 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10002
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010003 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10004 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10005 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10006 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10007 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010008
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010009 - set-src <expr> :
10010 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10011 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10012 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010013 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010015 Arguments:
10016 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10017 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010018
10019 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010020 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10021
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010022 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10023 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010024
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010025 - set-src-port <expr> :
10026 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10027 expression.
10028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010029 Arguments:
10030 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10031 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010032
10033 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010034 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10035
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010036 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10037 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10038 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010039
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010040 - set-dst <expr> :
10041 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10042 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10043 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10044 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10045 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10046
10047 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10048 followed by some converters.
10049
10050 Example:
10051
10052 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10053 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10054
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010055 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10056 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10057
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010058 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10059 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10060 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10061 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10062
10063
10064 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10065 followed by some converters.
10066
10067 Example:
10068
10069 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10070
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010071 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10072 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10073 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10074
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010075 - "silent-drop" :
10076 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010077 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010078 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10079 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10080 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10081 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10082 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010083 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10084 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010085 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10086 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010087 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010088 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10089 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10090 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10091 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010093 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10094 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10095 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010097 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10098 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10099 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010101 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010102 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010103 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010105 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10106 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10107 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010109 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010110 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10111 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010112
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010113 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10114
10115 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10116
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010117 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10118
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010119 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010120
10121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010122tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10123 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010125 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010126 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010127 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10128 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010132 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010133 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10134 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10135 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10136 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010138 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10139 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10140 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10141 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010142 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10143 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10144 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10145 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10146 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10147 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010148 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010149 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010151 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10152 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10153 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10154 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010155
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010156 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010157 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010158 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010159 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10160 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010161 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010162 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010163 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010164 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010165 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010166 - set-dst <expr>
10167 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010168 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010169 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010170 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010171 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010172 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10175 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010176 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10177 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010178
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010179 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10180 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10181 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10182 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10183 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10184 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010186 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010187 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10188 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010190 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010191 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10192 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10193 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10194 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010195 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10196 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10197 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010198
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010199 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010200 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10201 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10202 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010203
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010204 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10205 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10206
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010207 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010208 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10209 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010210
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010211 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10212 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010213 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010214 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10215 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010216 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010217 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010218 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010219 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10220 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010222 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10223 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010224
10225 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10226 followed by some converters.
10227
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010228 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10229 <var-name>.
10230
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010231 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10232 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10233 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10234 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10235 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10236
10237 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10238 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10239 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10240 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10241 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10242 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10243 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10244 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10245 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10246 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10247 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10248
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010249 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10250 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10251 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10252 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10253 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10254
10255 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10256
10257 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10258
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010259 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10260 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10261 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10262 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10263 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10264 evaluated.
10265
10266 Example:
10267 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10268
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010269 Example:
10270
10271 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010272 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010273
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010274 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010275 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10276 # and reject everything else.
10277 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10278 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010279 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010280 tcp-request content reject
10281
10282 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010283 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10284 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10285 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010286 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010287
10288 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10289 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10290 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010291 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 tcp-request content reject
10293
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010294 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010295 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010296 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010297 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010298 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10299 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010300
10301 Example:
10302 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10303 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010304 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010306 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010307 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010308
10309 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010310 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010311 # protecting all our sites
10312 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010313 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10314 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010315 ...
10316 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10317
10318 backend http_dynamic
10319 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010320 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010321 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010322 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010323 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010324 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010327 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010328
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010329 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10330 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010331
10332
10333tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10334 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010336 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010337 Arguments :
10338 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10339 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10340 as explained at the top of this document.
10341
10342 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10343 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10344 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10345 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10346 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10347
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010348 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10349 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10350 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10351 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10352
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010353 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10354 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010355 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010356 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010357 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10358 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10359 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10360 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010361
10362 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10363 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10364 it pass through unaffected.
10365
10366 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10367 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10368 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010369 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010370 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10371 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010372 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10373 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10374 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010375
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010376 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010377 "timeout client".
10378
10379
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010380tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10381 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10383 no | no | yes | yes
10384 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010385 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10386 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010387
10388 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10389
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010390 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010391 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10392 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010393 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10394 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010395
10396 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10397
10398 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10399 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10400 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10401 inserted.
10402
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010403 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010404 - accept :
10405 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10406 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10407 the rules evaluation.
10408
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010409 - close :
10410 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10411 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10412 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10413 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10414 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10415 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010416 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010417 protocols.
10418
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010419 - reject :
10420 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10421 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010422 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010423
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010424 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10425 Sets a variable.
10426
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010427 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10428 Unsets a variable.
10429
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010430 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10431 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10432 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10433 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10434
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010435 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10436 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10437 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10438 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10439
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010440 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10441 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10442 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10443 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10444 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010445
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010446 - "silent-drop" :
10447 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010448 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010449 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10450 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10451 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10452 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10453 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010454 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10455 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010456 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10457 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010458 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010459 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10460 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10461 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10462 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10463
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010464 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10465 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10466
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010467 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10468 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10469 for changing the default action to a reject.
10470
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010471 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10472 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10473 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10474 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010475 period.
10476
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010477 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10478 declared inline.
10479
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010480 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10481 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010482 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010483 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10484 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010485 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010486 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010487 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010488 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10489 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010490 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010491 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10492 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010493
10494 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10495 followed by some converters.
10496
10497 Example:
10498
10499 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10500
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010501 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10502 <var-name>.
10503
10504 Example:
10505
10506 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10507
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010508 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10509 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10510 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10511 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10512 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10513
10514 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10515
10516 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10517
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010518 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10519
10520 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10521
10522
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010523tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10524 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10526 no | yes | yes | no
10527 Arguments :
10528 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10529 below.
10530
10531 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010533 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010534 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10535 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10536 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10537 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10538 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10539 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10540 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010541 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010542 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10543 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10544 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10545 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10546 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10547 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10548 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10549 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10550 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10551 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10552 instead.
10553
10554 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10555 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10556 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10557 rules which may be inserted.
10558
10559 Several types of actions are supported :
10560 - accept : the request is accepted
10561 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10562 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10563 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010564 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010565 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010566 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010567 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010568 - silent-drop
10569
10570 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10571 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10572 sections for a complete description.
10573
10574 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10575 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10576 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10577
10578 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10579 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10580 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10581 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10582 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10583
10584 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10585 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10586
10587 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10588 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10589 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10590
10591 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10592 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10593 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10594
10595 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10596 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10597 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10598
10599 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10600 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10601 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10602
10603 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10604
10605 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10606
10607
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010608tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10609 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10611 no | no | yes | yes
10612 Arguments :
10613 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10614 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10615 as explained at the top of this document.
10616
10617 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10618
10619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010620timeout check <timeout>
10621 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10622 established.
10623
10624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10625 yes | no | yes | yes
10626 Arguments:
10627 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10628 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10629 as explained at the top of this document.
10630
10631 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10632 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010633 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010634 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010635 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10636 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10637 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010638
10639 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10640 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10641
10642 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10643 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010644 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010645
10646 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10647 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10648 forget about it.
10649
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010650 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10651 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010652
10653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010654timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010655 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10657 yes | yes | yes | no
10658 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010659 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010660 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10661 as explained at the top of this document.
10662
10663 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10664 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10665 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010666 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10667 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10668 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10669 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010670 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10671 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10672 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010673 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010674 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010675 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10676 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010677 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10678 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010679
10680 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10681 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10682 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10683 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010684 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010685 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10686
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010687 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010688
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010689 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010691
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010692timeout client-fin <timeout>
10693 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10695 yes | yes | yes | no
10696 Arguments :
10697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10699 as explained at the top of this document.
10700
10701 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10702 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10703 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10704 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10705 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10706 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10707 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010708 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10709 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10710 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010711
10712 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10713 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10714 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10715
10716 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10717
10718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010719timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010720 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10722 yes | no | yes | yes
10723 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10726 as explained at the top of this document.
10727
10728 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010729 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010730 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010731 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010732 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10733 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010734
10735 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10737 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10738 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010739 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010740 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10741
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010742 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010745timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10746 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10748 yes | yes | yes | yes
10749 Arguments :
10750 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10751 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10752 as explained at the top of this document.
10753
10754 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10755 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10756 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10757 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10758 once the request has started to present itself.
10759
10760 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10761 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10762 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10763 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10764 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10765
10766 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10767 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10768 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10769 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10770
10771 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10772 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010773 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010774 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10775 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010776 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010777
10778 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10779 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10780 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10781 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10782
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010783 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10784 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010785 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10786
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010787 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10788
10789
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010790timeout http-request <timeout>
10791 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010793 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10797 as explained at the top of this document.
10798
10799 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10800 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10801 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10802 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10803 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10804 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10805 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010806 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10807 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10808 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10809 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010810 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010811 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10812 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010813
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010814 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10815 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10816 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10817 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10818 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010819 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010820
10821 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10822 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010823 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010824 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10825 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10826
10827 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010828 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10829 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10830 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010831
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010832 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010833 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010834
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010835
10836timeout queue <timeout>
10837 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10839 yes | no | yes | yes
10840 Arguments :
10841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10843 as explained at the top of this document.
10844
10845 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10846 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10847 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10848 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10849 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10850
10851 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10852 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10853 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10854 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10855
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010856 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010857
10858
10859timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010860 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10862 yes | no | yes | yes
10863 Arguments :
10864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10866 as explained at the top of this document.
10867
10868 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10869 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10870 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10871 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10872 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10873 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10874 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10875
10876 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10877 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10878 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10879 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10880 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010881 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010882 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010883 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10884 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010885 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10886 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010887
10888 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10890 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10891 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010892 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010893 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10894
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010895 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010896
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010897
10898timeout server-fin <timeout>
10899 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10901 yes | no | yes | yes
10902 Arguments :
10903 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10904 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10905 as explained at the top of this document.
10906
10907 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10908 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10909 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10910 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10911 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10912 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10913 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10914 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10915 situations, it should not be needed.
10916
10917 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10918 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10919 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10920
10921 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10922
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010923
10924timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010925 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10927 yes | yes | yes | yes
10928 Arguments :
10929 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10930 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10931 as explained at the top of this document.
10932
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010933 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10934 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10935 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010936
10937 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10938 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10939 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10940 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010941 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010942
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010943 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010944
10945
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010946timeout tunnel <timeout>
10947 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10949 yes | no | yes | yes
10950 Arguments :
10951 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10952 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10953 as explained at the top of this document.
10954
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010955 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010956 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10957 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10958 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010959 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10960 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010961 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10962 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10963 specified.
10964
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010965 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10966 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10967 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10968 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10969 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10970 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10971 state.
10972
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010973 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10974 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10975 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10976 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010977 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010978
10979 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10980 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10981 forget about it.
10982
10983 Example :
10984 defaults http
10985 option http-server-close
10986 timeout connect 5s
10987 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010988 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010989 timeout server 30s
10990 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10991
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010992 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010993
10994
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010995transparent (deprecated)
10996 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010998 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010999 Arguments : none
11000
11001 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11002 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11003 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11004 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11005 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11006 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11007 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11008 appropriate server.
11009
11010 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11011
11012 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11013 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11014
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011015 See also: "option transparent"
11016
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011017unique-id-format <string>
11018 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11020 yes | yes | yes | no
11021 Arguments :
11022 <string> is a log-format string.
11023
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011024 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11025 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11026 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11027 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011028
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011029 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11030 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11031 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11032 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11033 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11034 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11035 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11036 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011037
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011038 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11039 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011040
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011041 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011042
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011043 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011044
11045 will generate:
11046
11047 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11048
11049 See also: "unique-id-header"
11050
11051unique-id-header <name>
11052 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11054 yes | yes | yes | no
11055 Arguments :
11056 <name> is the name of the header.
11057
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011058 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11059 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011060
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011061 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011062
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011063 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011064 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11065
11066 will generate:
11067
11068 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11069
11070 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011071
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011072use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011073 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11075 no | yes | yes | no
11076 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011077 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11078 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011079
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011080 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11081 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011082
11083 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11084 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11085 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011086 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011088 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11089 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011090
11091 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11092 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11093 assign the backend.
11094
11095 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11096 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11097 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11098 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11099 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11100 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11101
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011102 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011103 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011104 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11105 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11106 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11107
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011108 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11109 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11110 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11111 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11112 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11113 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11114 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11115 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11116 cannot be forced from the request.
11117
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011118 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011119 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11120 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11121
11122 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11123 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011125use-fcgi-app <name>
11126 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11128 no | no | yes | yes
11129 Arguments :
11130 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11131
11132 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011133
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011134use-server <server> if <condition>
11135use-server <server> unless <condition>
11136 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11138 no | no | yes | yes
11139 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011140 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011141
11142 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11143
11144 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11145 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11146 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11147
11148 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11149 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11150 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11151 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11152 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11153 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11154 matches will assign the server.
11155
11156 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11157 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11158 with the next rules until one matches.
11159
11160 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11161 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11162 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11163 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11164
11165 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11166 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11167 stripped.
11168
11169 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11170 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11171 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11172 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11173
11174 Example :
11175 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11176 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11177 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11178 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11179 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11180 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011181 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011182 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11183 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11184
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011185 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011186
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011187
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100111885. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011189--------------------------
11190
11191The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11192depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11193settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11194written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11195described in this section.
11196
11197
111985.1. Bind options
11199-----------------
11200
11201The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11202as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11203no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11204parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11205while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11206provided immediately after the setting name.
11207
11208The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11209
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011210accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11211 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11212 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11213 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11214 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11215 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11216 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11217 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11218 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11219 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011220 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11221 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11222 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011224accept-proxy
11225 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011226 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11227 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011228 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11229 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11230 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11231 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011232 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011233 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11234 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011235 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11236 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011237
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011238allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011239 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011240 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011241 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011242 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11243 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011244
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011245alpn <protocols>
11246 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11247 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11248 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011249 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011250 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011251 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11252 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11253 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11254 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11255 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11256 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11257 preference, like below :
11258
11259 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011261backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011262 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011263 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11264
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011265curves <curves>
11266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11267 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11268 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11269 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11270 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11271 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11272
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011273ecdhe <named curve>
11274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011275 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11276 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011277
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011278ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11280 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11281 client's certificate.
11282
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011283ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11285 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11286 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11287 error is ignored.
11288
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011289ca-sign-file <cafile>
11290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11291 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11292 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11293 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11294 'generate-certificates' for details.
11295
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011296ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11298 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11299 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11300 'generate-certificates' for details.
11301
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011302ciphers <ciphers>
11303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11304 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011305 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011306 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011307 information and recommendations see e.g.
11308 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11309 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11310 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11311
11312ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11314 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11315 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11316 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011317 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11318 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011319
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011320crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11322 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11323 to verify client's certificate.
11324
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011325crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11327 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11328 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11329 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11330 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011331 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11332 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011333
11334 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11335 are loaded.
11336
11337 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011338 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011339 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11340 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11341 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11342 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011343 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11344 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011345 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011346
11347 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11348 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11349 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11350 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011351 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11352 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011353
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011354 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011355
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011356 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011357 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011358 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11359 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011360 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11361 clients).
11362
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011363 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11364 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11365 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11366 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11367 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11368 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11369 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11370 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11371 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11372 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11373 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11374 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11375 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11376
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011377 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11378 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11379 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11380 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11381 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11382
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011383 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11384 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11385 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11386 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011387
11388 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11389 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11390 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11391 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11392 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11393 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11394 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11395 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11396 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11397
11398 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11399
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011400 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011401 a cert bundle.
11402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011403 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011404 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11405 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11406 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11407 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11408 provide multi-cert support.
11409
11410 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11411
11412 Filename | CN | SAN
11413 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11414 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011415 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011416 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11417 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11418
11419 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11420 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11421 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11422 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011423 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11424 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11425 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011426
11427 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11428 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11429
11430 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11431 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11432 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11433
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011434crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011436 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011437 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011438 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011439
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011440crt-list <file>
11441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011442 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11443 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011444
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011445 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11446
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011447 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11448 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011449 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011450 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011451
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011452 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11453 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11454 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11455 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11456 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11457 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11458 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11459 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011460
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011461 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011462 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011463 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11464 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11465 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011466
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011467 crt-list file example:
11468 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011469 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011470 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011471 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011472
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011473defer-accept
11474 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11475 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11476 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011477 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011478 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11479 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11480 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11481 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11482 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11483 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11484 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11485
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011486expose-fd listeners
11487 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11488 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011489 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11490 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011491 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011492
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011493force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011494 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011495 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011496 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011497 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011498
11499force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011500 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011501 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011502 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011503
11504force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011505 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011506 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011507 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011508
11509force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011510 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011511 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011512 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011513
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011514force-tlsv13
11515 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11516 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011517 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011518
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011519generate-certificates
11520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11521 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11522 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11523 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11524 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11525 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11526 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11527 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11528 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11529 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11530 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11531
11532 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11533 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011534 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011535 certificate is used many times.
11536
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011537gid <gid>
11538 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11539 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11540 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11541 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11542 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11543
11544group <group>
11545 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11546 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11547 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11548 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11549 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11550
11551id <id>
11552 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11553 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11554 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11555 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11556
11557interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011558 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11559 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11560 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11561 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11562 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11563 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011564 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11565 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11566 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11567 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11568 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11569 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011570
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011571level <level>
11572 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11573 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11574 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011575 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011576 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11577 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11578 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011579 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011580 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011581 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011582 all counters).
11583
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011584severity-output <format>
11585 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11586 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11587 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11588 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11589 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11590 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11591 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11592 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11593 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11594 rfc5424 convention.
11595
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011596maxconn <maxconn>
11597 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11598 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11599 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11600 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11601 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11602 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11603 eat all memory.
11604
11605mode <mode>
11606 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11607 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11608 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11609 UNIX sockets.
11610
11611mss <maxseg>
11612 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11613 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11614 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11615 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11616 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11617 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11618 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11619 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11620 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11621 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11622 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11623
11624name <name>
11625 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11626 page.
11627
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011628namespace <name>
11629 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11630 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11631 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11632 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011634nice <nice>
11635 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11636 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11637 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11638 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11639 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11640 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11641 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11642 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11643 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11644 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11645 one for an RDP socket.
11646
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011647no-ca-names
11648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11649 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11650
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011651no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011653 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011654 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011655 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011656 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11657 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011658
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011659no-tls-tickets
11660 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11661 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11662 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011663 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11664 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011665
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011666no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011668 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011669 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011670 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011671 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11672 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011673
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011674no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011676 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011677 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011678 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011679 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11680 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011681
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011682no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011684 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011685 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011686 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011687 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11688 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011689
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011690no-tlsv13
11691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11692 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11693 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11694 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011695 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11696 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011697
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011698npn <protocols>
11699 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11700 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11701 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011702 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011703 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011704 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11705 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11706 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11707 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11708 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011709
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011710prefer-client-ciphers
11711 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11712 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11713 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011714 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11715 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11716 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011717
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011718process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011719 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011720 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011721 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011722 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11723 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11724 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11725 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011727 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11728 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11729 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11730 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11731 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011732
11733 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11734
11735 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11736 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11737 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11738 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11739 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11740 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11741 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11742 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011743
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011744proto <name>
11745 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11746 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11747 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11748 in haproxy -vv.
11749 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11750 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011751 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011752 h2" on the bind line.
11753
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011754ssl
11755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011756 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011757 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11758 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011759 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11760 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011761
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011762ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11763 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11764 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11765 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11766
11767ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11768 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11769 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11770 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11771
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011772strict-sni
11773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11774 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11775 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11776 See the "crt" option for more information.
11777
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011778tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011779 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011780 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11781 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011782 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011783 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11784 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11785 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11786 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11787 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11788 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11789 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11790
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011791tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011792 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011793 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11794 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11795 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11796 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11797 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11798 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11799 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011800 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11801 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11802 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011803
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011804tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11805 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011806 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11807 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11808 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11809 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11810 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11811 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11812 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11813 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11814 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11815 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011816 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11817 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11818
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011819transparent
11820 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11821 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11822 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11823 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11824 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11825 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11826 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11827 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11828 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11829 so check for support with your vendor.
11830
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011831v4v6
11832 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11833 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11834 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11835 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011836 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011837
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011838v6only
11839 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11840 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11841 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011842 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11843 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011845uid <uid>
11846 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11847 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11848 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11849 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11850 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11851
11852user <user>
11853 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11854 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11855 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11856 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11857 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11858
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011859verify [none|optional|required]
11860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11861 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11862 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11863 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11864 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011865 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11866 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11867 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11868 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200118705.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011871------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011873The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11874which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11875arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11876settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11877after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11878Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11879address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011881 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011882 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011883
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011884Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11885keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011887The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011888
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011889addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011890 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011891 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11892 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11893 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11894 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11895 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011896
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011897agent-check
11898 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011899 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011900 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11901 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11902 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011903
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011904 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011905 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011906 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11907 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11908 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011909
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011910 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11911 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11912 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11913 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11914 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011915
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011916 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011917 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011918
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011919 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11920 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11921 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011922
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011923 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11924 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11925 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011926
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011927 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11928 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11929 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11930 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11931 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011932 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011933 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011934
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011935 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11936 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011937
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011938 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11939 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11940 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11941 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11942 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11943 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11944 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11945 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11946 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011947
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011948 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11949 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011950 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11951 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11952 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011953 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011954
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011955 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011956 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011957
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011958agent-send <string>
11959 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11960 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11961 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11962 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11963 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11964
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011965agent-inter <delay>
11966 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11967 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11968
11969 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11970 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11971 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11972 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11973 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11974 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11975 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11976 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11977 of backends use the same servers.
11978
11979 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11980
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011981agent-addr <addr>
11982 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11983
11984 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11985 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11986 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11987 hostname, it will be resolved.
11988
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011989agent-port <port>
11990 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11991
11992 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11993
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011994allow-0rtt
11995 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011996 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11997 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011998
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011999alpn <protocols>
12000 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12001 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12002 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012003 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012004 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12005 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12006 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12007 now obsolete NPN extension.
12008 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12009 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12010
12011 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012013backup
12014 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12015 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12016 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12017 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012018 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12019 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012020
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012021ca-file <cafile>
12022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12023 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12024 server's certificate.
12025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012026check
12027 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012028 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12029 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12030 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12031 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12032 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12033 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12034 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012035 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12036 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012037 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12038 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012039
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012040check-send-proxy
12041 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12042 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12043 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12044 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12045 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12046 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12047 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12048
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012049check-alpn <protocols>
12050 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12051 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12052 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12053
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012054check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012055 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012056 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12057 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012058
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012059check-ssl
12060 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12061 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12062 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12063 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012064 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012065 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12066 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012067 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012068 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12069 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012070
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012071check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012072 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012073 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12074 for normal traffic.
12075
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012076ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12078 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12079 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012080 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12081 information and recommendations see e.g.
12082 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12083 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12084 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012085
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012086ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12088 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12089 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12090 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012091 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12092 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12093 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012095cookie <value>
12096 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12097 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12098 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12099 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12100 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12101 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12102 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12103
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012104crl-file <crlfile>
12105 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12106 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12107 to verify server's certificate.
12108
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012109crt <cert>
12110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12111 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12112 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12113 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12114 certificate request.
12115
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012116disabled
12117 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12118 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12119 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12120 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12121 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012122 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012123
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012124enabled
12125 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12126 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12127 default value.
12128 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12129 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012131error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012132 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12133 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12134 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012136 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012138fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012139 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12140 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12141 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12142
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012143force-sslv3
12144 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12145 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012146 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012147 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012148
12149force-tlsv10
12150 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012151 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012152 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012153
12154force-tlsv11
12155 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012156 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012157 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012158
12159force-tlsv12
12160 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012161 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012162 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012163
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012164force-tlsv13
12165 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12166 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012167 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012169id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012170 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12171 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12172 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012173
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012174init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12175 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12176 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012178 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12179 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12180 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12181 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12182 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12183 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12184 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12185 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12186 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012187 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012188 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12189 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12190 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12191 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12192 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12193 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012194 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012195
12196 Example:
12197 defaults
12198 # never fail on address resolution
12199 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012201inter <delay>
12202fastinter <delay>
12203downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12205 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12206 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12207 between checks depending on the server state :
12208
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012209 Server state | Interval used
12210 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12211 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12212 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12213 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12214 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12215 or yet unchecked. |
12216 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12217 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12218 | "inter" otherwise.
12219 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012221 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12222 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12223 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12224 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012225 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12226 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12227 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12228 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12229 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012231maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012232 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12233 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012234 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12235 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012236 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12237 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12238 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12239 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12240
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012241 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12242 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12243 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12244 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12245 than 50 concurrent requests.
12246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012247maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012248 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12249 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12250 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12251 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12252 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12253 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12254 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12255
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012256max-reuse <count>
12257 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12258 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12259 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12260 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12261 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12262 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12263 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12264 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012266minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012267 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12268 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12269 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12270 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12271 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12272 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012273 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012274 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012275
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012276namespace <name>
12277 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12278 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12279 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12280 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12281
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012282no-agent-check
12283 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12284 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12285 default value.
12286 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12287 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12288
12289no-backup
12290 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12291 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12292 default value.
12293 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12294 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12295
12296no-check
12297 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12298 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12299 default value.
12300 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12301 "default-server" "check" setting.
12302
12303no-check-ssl
12304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12306 default value.
12307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12308 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12309
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012310no-send-proxy
12311 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12312 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12313 default value.
12314 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12315 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12316
12317no-send-proxy-v2
12318 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12319 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12320 default value.
12321 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12322 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12323
12324no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12325 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12326 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12327 default value.
12328 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12329 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12330
12331no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12332 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12333 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12334 default value.
12335 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12336 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12337
12338no-ssl
12339 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12340 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12341 default value.
12342 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12343 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12344
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012345no-ssl-reuse
12346 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12347 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12348 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12349 and for paranoid users.
12350
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012351no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012352 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12353 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012354 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012355
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012356 Supported in default-server: No
12357
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012358no-tls-tickets
12359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12360 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12361 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012362 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12363 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012364 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012365
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012366no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012367 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012368 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12369 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012370 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12371 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012372 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012373
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012374 Supported in default-server: No
12375
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012376no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012377 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012378 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12379 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012380 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12381 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012382 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012383
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012384 Supported in default-server: No
12385
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012386no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012387 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012388 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12389 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012390 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12391 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012392 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012393
12394 Supported in default-server: No
12395
12396no-tlsv13
12397 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12398 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12399 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12400 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12401 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012402 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012403
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012404 Supported in default-server: No
12405
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012406no-verifyhost
12407 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12408 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12409 default value.
12410 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12411 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012412
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012413no-tfo
12414 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12415 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12416 default value.
12417 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12418 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12419
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012420non-stick
12421 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12422 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12423 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12424
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012425npn <protocols>
12426 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12427 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12428 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012429 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012430 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12431 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12432 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012434observe <mode>
12435 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12436 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12437 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12438 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12439 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12440 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012441 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012442
12443 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012445on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012446 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12447 Currently, four modes are available:
12448 - fastinter: force fastinter
12449 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12450 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12451 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12452 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12453
12454 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12455
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012456on-marked-down <action>
12457 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12458 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012459 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12460 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12461 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12462 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12463 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12464 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12465 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12466 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012467
12468 Actions are disabled by default
12469
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012470on-marked-up <action>
12471 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12472 Currently one action is available:
12473 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12474 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12475 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12476 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012477 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12478 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012479 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12480 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12481
12482 Actions are disabled by default
12483
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012484pool-max-conn <max>
12485 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12486 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12487 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12488 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12489 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12490 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12491
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012492pool-purge-delay <delay>
12493 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012494 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012495 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012497port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012498 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12499 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12500 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12501 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12502 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12503 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12504
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012505proto <name>
12506
12507 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12508 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12509 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12510 reported in haproxy -vv.
12511 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12512 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012514redir <prefix>
12515 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12516 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12517 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12518 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12519 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12520 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12521 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12522 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012523 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012524 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012525 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12526 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12527 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12528 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12529
12530 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012532rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012533 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12534 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12535 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12536
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012537resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12538 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12539 server.
12540
12541 Available options:
12542
12543 * allow-dup-ip
12544 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12545 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12546 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12547 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12548 For such case, simply enable this option.
12549 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12550
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012551 * ignore-weight
12552 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12553 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12554 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12555
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012556 * prevent-dup-ip
12557 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12558 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12559 same fqdn.
12560 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12561
12562 Example:
12563 backend b_myapp
12564 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12565 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12566 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12567
12568 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12569 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12570 it
12571 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12572 different address
12573
12574 Default value: not set
12575
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012576resolve-prefer <family>
12577 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12578 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12579 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12580 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12581
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012582 Default value: ipv6
12583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012584 Example:
12585
12586 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012587
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012588resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012589 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012590 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012591 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012592 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12593 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012594 configured network, another address is selected.
12595
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012596 Example:
12597
12598 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012599
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012600resolvers <id>
12601 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12602 hostname.
12603
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012604 Example:
12605
12606 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012608 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012609
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012610send-proxy
12611 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12612 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12613 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12614 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012615 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12616 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12617 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12618 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12619 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12620 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12621 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12622 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12623 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12624 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012625 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12626 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012627
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012628send-proxy-v2
12629 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12630 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12631 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12632 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012633 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12634 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12635 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12636 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012637
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012638proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12639 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12640 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012641 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12642 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012643 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12644 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012645 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012646
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012647send-proxy-v2-ssl
12648 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12649 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12650 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12651 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12652 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12653 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12654 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012655 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12656 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012657
12658send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12659 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12660 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12661 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12662 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12663 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12664 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12665 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12666 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012667 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12668 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012670slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012671 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12672 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12673 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12674 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12675 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12676 parameters :
12677
12678 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12679 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12680
12681 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12682 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12683 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12684 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12685
12686 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12687 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12688 seen as failed.
12689
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012690sni <expression>
12691 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12692 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12693 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12694 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012695 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12696 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012697 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012698 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12699 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012700
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012701source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012702source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012703source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012704 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12705 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12706 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12707 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12708
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012709 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12710 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12711 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12712 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12713 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12714 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12715 server.
12716
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012717 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12718 specifying the source address without port(s).
12719
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012720ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012721 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12722 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12723 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12724 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12725 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12726 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012727 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12728 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012729
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012730ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12731 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12732 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12733 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12734
12735ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12736 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12737 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12738 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12739
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012740ssl-reuse
12741 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12742 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12743 default value.
12744 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12745 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12746
12747stick
12748 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12749 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12750 default value.
12751 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12752 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012753
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012754socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012755 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012756 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12757 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12758
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012759tcp-ut <delay>
12760 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12761 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12762 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012763 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012764 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12765 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12766 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12767 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12768 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12769 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12770 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12771 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12772 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12773
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012774tfo
12775 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12776 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12777 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12778 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12779 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012780 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012781
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012782track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012783 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12784 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12785 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12786 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012787 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12788
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012789tls-tickets
12790 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12791 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12792 default value.
12793 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12794 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012795
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012796verify [none|required]
12797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012798 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012799 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12800 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012801 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012802 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12803 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12804 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12805 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12806 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12807 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12808 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12809 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012810
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012811verifyhost <hostname>
12812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012813 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12814 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12815 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12816 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12817 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12818 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12819 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12820 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012822weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012823 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12824 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12825 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012826 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12827 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12828 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12829 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12830 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12831 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012832
12833
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12835-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012836
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012837HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12838using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12839configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012840This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12841can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12842workload.
12843This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12844resolution at run time.
12845Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12846carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12847
12848
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128495.3.1. Global overview
12850----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012851
12852As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12853different steps of the process life:
12854
12855 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12856 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12857 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12858
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012859 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12860 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012861
12862A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12863 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12864 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12865 resolution to know this new IP.
12866
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012867When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012868HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012869SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12870from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12871will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12872will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012873
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012874A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012875 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012876 first valid response.
12877
12878 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12879 servers return an error.
12880
12881
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200128825.3.2. The resolvers section
12883----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012884
12885This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012886HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12887contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012888
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012889When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12890uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12891is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12892answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12893
12894When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012895used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012896
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012897 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12898 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12899 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012900
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012901 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12902 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012903
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012904 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12905 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12906 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012907
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012908For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12909following scenarios are possible:
12910
12911 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12912 ignored
12913
12914 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12915 applied
12916
12917 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12918 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12919
12920 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12921 retries the query with a new type
12922
12923 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12924 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012925
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012926As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12927a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012928<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012929
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012930
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012931resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012932 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012933
12934A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12935
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012936accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012937 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012938 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012939 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12940 by RFC 6891)
12941
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012942 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12943
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012944nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12945 DNS server description:
12946 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12947 <ip> : IP address of the server
12948 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12949
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012950parse-resolv-conf
12951 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12952 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12953 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12954
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012955hold <status> <period>
12956 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12957 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012958 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012959 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012960 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12961 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12962 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12963
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012964 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012965
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012966resolve_retries <nb>
12967 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12968 giving up.
12969 Default value: 3
12970
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012971 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12972 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12973 type.
12974
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012975timeout <event> <time>
12976 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12977 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12978 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012979 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12980 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012981 Default value: 1s
12982 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012983 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012984 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012985 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12986 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12987
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012988 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012989
12990 resolvers mydns
12991 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12992 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012993 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012994 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012995 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012996 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012997 hold other 30s
12998 hold refused 30s
12999 hold nx 30s
13000 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013001 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013002 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013003
13004
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200130056. Cache
13006---------
13007
13008HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13009(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13010RAM.
13011
13012The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13013this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13014
13015If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13016independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13017when we try to allocate a new one.
13018
13019The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13020
13021It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13022"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13023for more details.
13024
13025When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13026replaced by "<CACHE>".
13027
13028
130296.1. Limitation
13030----------------
13031
13032The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13033
13034- If the response is not a 200
13035- If the response contains a Vary header
13036- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13037- If the response is not cacheable
13038
13039- If the request is not a GET
13040- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13041- If the request contains an Authorization header
13042
13043
130446.2. Setup
13045-----------
13046
13047To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13048the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13049
13050
130516.2.1. Cache section
13052---------------------
13053
13054cache <name>
13055 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13056 size of cache is mandatory.
13057
13058total-max-size <megabytes>
13059 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13060 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13061
13062max-object-size <bytes>
13063 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13064 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13065 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13066
13067max-age <seconds>
13068 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13069 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13070 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13071 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13072 default.
13073
13074
130756.2.2. Proxy section
13076---------------------
13077
13078http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13079 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13080 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13081 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13082 after this one.
13083
13084http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13085 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13086 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13087 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13088 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13089
13090
13091Example:
13092
13093 backend bck1
13094 mode http
13095
13096 http-request cache-use foobar
13097 http-response cache-store foobar
13098 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13099
13100 cache foobar
13101 total-max-size 4
13102 max-age 240
13103
13104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13106----------------------------------
13107
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013109client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13110The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13111these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13112but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13113data called patterns.
13114
13115
131167.1. ACL basics
13117---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013118
13119The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13120content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13121from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13122simple :
13123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013125 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13127 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013129The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13130adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013131
13132In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013134 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013135
13136This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13137Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13138and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013139an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13140conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13141as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13142are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013143
13144ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13145'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13146which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13147
13148There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13149performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13152specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13153this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013154methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13155ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156
13157Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13158 - boolean
13159 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13160 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13161 - string
13162 - data block
13163
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013164Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13165converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13166would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13167The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13168which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13169
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013170Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13171keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13172fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13173which are summarized in the table below :
13174
13175 +---------------------+-----------------+
13176 | Sample or converter | Default |
13177 | output type | matching method |
13178 +---------------------+-----------------+
13179 | boolean | bool |
13180 +---------------------+-----------------+
13181 | integer | int |
13182 +---------------------+-----------------+
13183 | ip | ip |
13184 +---------------------+-----------------+
13185 | string | str |
13186 +---------------------+-----------------+
13187 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13188 +---------------------+-----------------+
13189
13190Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13191matching method, see below.
13192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013193The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13194 - boolean
13195 - integer or integer range
13196 - IP address / network
13197 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13198 - regular expression
13199 - hex block
13200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013201The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13202
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013203 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13204 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013205 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013206 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013207 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013208 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013209 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13212read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13213if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13214lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13215will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13216beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13217a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13218lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13219exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13220
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013221The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13222parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13223ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13224a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13225check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13226
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013227The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13228socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13229file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13232loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13233
13234 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13235
13236In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13237the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13238case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13239as well.
13240
13241The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13242sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13243do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13244methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13245is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013246obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013247followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13248default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13249that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13250string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13251
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013252The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13253By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13254string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13255resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13256server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013257waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013258flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13259function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13262sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13263be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013264
13265 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13266 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13268 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13269 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13270 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013271
13272 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13273 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013274 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013275
13276 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013278
13279 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013280 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013282 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013283 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13284
13285 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13286 binary or string samples.
13287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13289 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13292 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13293 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013295 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13296 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13299 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13302 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13305 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013306 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13309 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13310 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013311
13312For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13313request, it is possible to do :
13314
13315 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13316
13317In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13318buffer, one would use the following acl :
13319
13320 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13321
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013322On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13323possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13324
13325 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013327All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13328criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13329method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13330to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13331criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13332the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013335the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13336For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13339 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13340 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13341 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013342
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013343
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013344The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13345types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13346combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13347brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13348default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350 +-------------------------------------------------+
13351 | Input sample type |
13352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013353 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13355 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013357 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013359 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013361 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013363 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013365 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013367 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013369 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013371 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013373 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013374 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013375 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013377 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13379 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13380 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013381
13382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133837.1.1. Matching booleans
13384------------------------
13385
13386In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13387Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13388When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13389that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13390
13391Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13392return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13393"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133967.1.2. Matching integers
13397------------------------
13398
13399Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13400enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13401to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13402
13403Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13404matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13405lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013406
13407For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13408unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13409representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13410
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013411As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13412two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13413instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13414ranges and operators.
13415
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013416For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013417operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13418Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13419of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013421Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013422
13423 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13424 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13425 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13426 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13427 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013429For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013430
13431 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13432
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013433This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13434
13435 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134387.1.3. Matching strings
13439-----------------------
13440
13441String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13442different forms :
13443
13444 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446
13447 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449
13450 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13451 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13452
13453 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13454 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13455
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013456 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13458 matches.
13459
13460 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13461 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13462 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013463
13464String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13465exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13466characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13467string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13468to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013469before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013470
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013471Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13472(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13473Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13474
13475Example:
13476 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13477 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13478
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13481---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013482
13483Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13484they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13485possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13486passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13487the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013488the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13489match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013490
13491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13493-------------------------------------
13494
13495It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13496not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13497a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13498to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13499digits may be used upper or lower case.
13500
13501Example :
13502 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13503 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13504
13505
135067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13507---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013508
13509IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13510netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13511within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013512host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013513difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13514at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13515does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13516parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013517
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013518The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13519abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13520
13521 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13522 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13523 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13524 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13525 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13526 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13527 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13528 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13529
13530Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13531192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13532
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013533IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13534Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13535trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13536IPv6 patterns.
13537
13538HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13539following situations :
13540 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13541 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13542 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13543 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13544 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13545 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13546 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13547 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13548 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13549 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013551
135527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13553----------------------------------
13554
13555Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13556combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13557
13558 - AND (implicit)
13559 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13560 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013564 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013566Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13567indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13570"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13571requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13572is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13573
13574 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013575 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13576 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13577 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013578
13579To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13580and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13581
13582 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13583 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13584 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13585 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13586
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013587 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013588 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13589 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13590 use_backend www if host_www
13591
13592It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13593expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13594be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13595the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13596
13597 The following rule :
13598
13599 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013600 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013601
13602 Can also be written that way :
13603
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013604 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605
13606It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13607to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13608simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13609sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13610good use is the following :
13611
13612 With named ACLs :
13613
13614 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13615 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13616 monitor fail if site_dead
13617
13618 With anonymous ACLs :
13619
13620 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13621
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013622See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13623keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624
13625
136267.3. Fetching samples
13627---------------------
13628
13629Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13630against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13631sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13632ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13633of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13634available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13635
13636This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13637Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13638compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13639deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13640
13641The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13642matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13643method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13644indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13645
13646As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13647when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13648mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13649the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13650ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13651
13652Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13653multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13654when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013655incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13656are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013657is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13658all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13659
13660Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13661 - name
13662 - name(arg1)
13663 - name(arg1,arg2)
13664
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013665
136667.3.1. Converters
13667-----------------
13668
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013669Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13670of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13671is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13672was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013673has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013674unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13675
13676These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13677sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13678the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013679support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013680
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013681A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13682support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13683supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13684(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13685bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013687The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013688
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001368951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13690 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13691 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13692 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13693 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13694 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13695
13696 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013697 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13698 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013699 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13700 frontend http-in
13701 bind *:8081
13702 default_backend servers
13703 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13704 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13705
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013706add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013707 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013708 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013709 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13710 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013711 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013712 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13713 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13714 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13715 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013716 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013717 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013718
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013719aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13720 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13721 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13722 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13723 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13724 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13725 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13726
13727 Example:
13728 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13729 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13730
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013731and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013732 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013733 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013734 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13735 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013736 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013737 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13738 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13740 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013742 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013743
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013744b64dec
13745 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13746 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13747
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013748base64
13749 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013751 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13752
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013753bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013754 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013755 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013756 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013757 presence of a flag).
13758
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013759bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13760 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13761 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013762 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013763
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013764concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13765 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13766 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13767 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13768 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13769 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13770 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13771 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13772 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13773 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13774 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013775 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
13776 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
13777 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
13778 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013779
13780 Example:
13781 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13782 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13783 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013784 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013785 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13786
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013787cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013788 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13789 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013790
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013791crc32([<avalanche>])
13792 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13793 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13794 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13795 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13796 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13797 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13798 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13799 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13800 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13801 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013802 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13803
13804crc32c([<avalanche>])
13805 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13806 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13807 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13808 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13809 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13810 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13811 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13812 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013813
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013814da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013815 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13816 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13817 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13818 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013819 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013820 configuration language.
13821
13822 Example:
13823 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013824 bind *:8881
13825 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013826 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013827
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013828debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13829 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13830 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13831 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13832 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13833 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13834 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13835 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13836 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13837 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13838 printable sample types.
13839
13840 Example:
13841 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013842
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013843div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013844 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13845 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013846 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013847 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13848 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013849 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013850 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13851 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13852 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13853 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013854 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013855 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013856
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013857djb2([<avalanche>])
13858 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13859 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13860 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13861 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13862 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13863 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13864 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013865 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13866 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013867
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013868even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013869 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013870 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13871
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013872field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13873 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13874 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13875 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13876 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13877 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13878 fields.
13879
13880 Example :
13881 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13882 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13883 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13884 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13885 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013886
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013887hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013888 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013889 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013890 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013891 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013892
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013893hex2i
13894 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013895 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013896
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013897http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013898 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13899 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013900 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13901 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13902 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13903 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13904 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13905 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13906 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13907 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013908
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013909in_table(<table>)
13910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13912 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013914 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13915
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013916ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13917 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013918 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013919 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13920 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13921 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13922 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13923 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013924
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013925json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013926 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013927 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013928 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013929 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13930 of errors:
13931 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13932 bytes, ...)
13933 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13934 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13935
13936 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13937 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13938 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13939 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13940 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13941 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013942 - "ascii" : never fails;
13943 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13944 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013945 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013946 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013947 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13948 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13949
13950 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013951 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013952
13953 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013954 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013955 capture request header user-agent len 150
13956 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013957
13958 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13959 GET / HTTP/1.0
13960 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13961
13962 Output log:
13963 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13964
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013965language(<value>[,<default>])
13966 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13967 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13968 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13969 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13970 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13971 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13972 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13973 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13974 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013975 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013976 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13977 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013978
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013979 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013980
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013981 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13982 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013983
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013984 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13985 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13986 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13987 use_backend spanish if es
13988 use_backend french if fr
13989 use_backend english if en
13990 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013991
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013992length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013993 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13994 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13995 type. The result is of type integer.
13996
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013997lower
13998 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13999 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14000 type. The result is of type string.
14001
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014002ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14003 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14004 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14005 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14006 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14007 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14008 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14009
14010 Example :
14011
14012 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014013 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014014 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014016map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14017map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14018map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14019 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14020 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14021 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14022 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14023 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14024 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14025 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14026 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014028 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14029 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14030 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014031
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014032 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014033 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014034
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014035 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14036 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14037 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14038 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014039 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14040 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014041 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14042 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14043 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14044 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14045 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14046 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14047 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14048 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014049 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14050 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14051 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014052 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14053 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14054 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14055 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14056 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014057
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014058 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14059 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14060 the corresponding match text.
14061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014062 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14063 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14064 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14065 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14066 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014067
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014068 Example :
14069
14070 # this is a comment and is ignored
14071 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14072 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14073 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14074 | | | `---------- value
14075 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14076 | `---------------------------- key
14077 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14078
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014079mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014080 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14081 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014082 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014083 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014084 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014085 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14086 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14087 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14088 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014090 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014091
14092mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014093 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014094 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14095 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014096 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014097 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014098 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014099 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14100 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14101 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14102 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014103 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014104 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014105
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014106nbsrv
14107 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14108 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14109 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14110 map lookup.
14111
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014112neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014113 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14114 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14115 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14116 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014117
14118not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014119 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014120 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014121 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014122 absence of a flag).
14123
14124odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014125 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014126 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14127
14128or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014129 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014130 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014131 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14132 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014133 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014134 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14135 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14136 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14137 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014138 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014139 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014140
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014141protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14142 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14143 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14144 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14145 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14146 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14147 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14148 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14149 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14150 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14151 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14152 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14153
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014154regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014155 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14156 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14157 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14158 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14159 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14160 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14161 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14162 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14163 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014164 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14165 of characters with other ones.
14166
14167 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14168 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14169 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14170 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14171 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14172 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014173
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014174 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014175
14176 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14177 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14178 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014179 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014180
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014181 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14182 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14183
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014184 # capture groups and backreferences
14185 # both lines do the same.
14186 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14187 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14188
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014189capture-req(<id>)
14190 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14191 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14192
14193 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014194 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14195 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014196
14197capture-res(<id>)
14198 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14199 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14200
14201 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014202 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14203 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014204
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014205sdbm([<avalanche>])
14206 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14207 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14208 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14209 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14210 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14211 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14212 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014213 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14214 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014215
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014216set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014217 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14218 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14219 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014220 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014221 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14222 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014223 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014224 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14225 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014226 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014227 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014228
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014229sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014230 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014231 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14232
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014233sha2([<bits>])
14234 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14235 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14236
14237 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14238 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14239
14240 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14241 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14242
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014243srv_queue
14244 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14245 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14246 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14247 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14248 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14249
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014250strcmp(<var>)
14251 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14252 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14253 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14254 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14255 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14256 shorter).
14257
14258 Example :
14259
14260 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14261 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14262 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14263
14264
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014265sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014266 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14267 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014268 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014269 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14270 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014271 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014272 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14273 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014274 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014275 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14276 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014277 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014278 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014279
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014280table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14281 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14282 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14283 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14284 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14285 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14286 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14287
14288
14289table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14292 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14293 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14294 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14295 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14296
14297table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14298 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14299 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014300 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014301 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14302 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14303
14304table_conn_cur(<table>)
14305 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14306 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14307 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14308 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14309 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14310
14311table_conn_rate(<table>)
14312 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14313 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14314 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14315 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14316 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14317
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014318table_gpt0(<table>)
14319 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14320 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14321 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14322 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14323 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14324
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014325table_gpc0(<table>)
14326 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14327 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14328 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14329 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14330 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14331
14332table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14336 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14337 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14338 sample fetch keyword.
14339
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014340table_gpc1(<table>)
14341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14344 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14345 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14346
14347table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14348 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14349 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14350 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14351 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14352 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14353 sample fetch keyword.
14354
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014355table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14356 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14357 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014358 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014359 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14360 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14361
14362table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14363 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14364 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14365 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14366 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14367 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14368 keyword.
14369
14370table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14371 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14372 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014373 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014374 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14375 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14376
14377table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14378 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14379 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14380 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14381 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14382 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14383 keyword.
14384
14385table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14386 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14387 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014388 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014389 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14390 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14391 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14392 keyword.
14393
14394table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14395 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14396 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014397 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014398 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14399 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14400 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14401 keyword.
14402
14403table_server_id(<table>)
14404 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14405 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14406 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14407 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14408 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14409 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14410
14411table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014414 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014415 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14416 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14417 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14418 keyword.
14419
14420table_sess_rate(<table>)
14421 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14422 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14423 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14424 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14425 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14426 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14427 keyword.
14428
14429table_trackers(<table>)
14430 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14431 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14432 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14433 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14434 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14435 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14436 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14437 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14438 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14439 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14440
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014441upper
14442 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14443 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14444 type. The result is of type string.
14445
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014446url_dec
14447 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14448 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14449
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014450ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014451 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014452 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14453 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14454 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014455 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14456 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14457 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14458 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014459 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014460 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14461 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014462
14463 Example:
14464 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14465 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14466
14467 message Point {
14468 int32 latitude = 1;
14469 int32 longitude = 2;
14470 }
14471
14472 message PPoint {
14473 Point point = 59;
14474 }
14475
14476 message Rectangle {
14477 // One corner of the rectangle.
14478 PPoint lo = 48;
14479 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14480 PPoint hi = 49;
14481 }
14482
14483 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14484 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14485 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14486
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014487 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14488 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014489 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014490 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14491
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014492 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014493
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014494 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014495
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014496 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014497 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14498 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14499
14500 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14501 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14502 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14503
14504 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14505 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14506 interpret the previous binary sample.
14507
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014508
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014509unset-var(<var name>)
14510 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14511 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14512 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14513 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14514 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14515 response),
14516 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14517 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14519 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14520
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014521utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14522 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14523 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14524 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14525 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14526 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14527 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14528
14529 Example :
14530
14531 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014532 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014533 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14534
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014535word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14536 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14537 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14538 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014539 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014540 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14541 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14542
14543 Example :
14544 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14545 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14546 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14547 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14548 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014549 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014550
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014551wt6([<avalanche>])
14552 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14553 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14554 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14555 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14556 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14557 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14558 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014559 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14560 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014561
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014562xor(<value>)
14563 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014564 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014565 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014566 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014567 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014568 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14569 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014570 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014571 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14572 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014573 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014574 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014575
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014576xxh32([<seed>])
14577 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14578 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14579 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14580 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14581 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14582 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14583 as cryptographically secure.
14584
14585xxh64([<seed>])
14586 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14587 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14588 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14589 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14590 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14591 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14592 as cryptographically secure.
14593
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145957.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596--------------------------------------------
14597
14598A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14599not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14600"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14601The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14602
14603always_false : boolean
14604 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14605 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14606
14607always_true : boolean
14608 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14609 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14610
14611avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014612 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14614 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14615 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14616 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14617 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14618 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14619 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14620 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14621 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14622 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14623 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14624 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14625 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014628 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14629 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14630 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14631 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014632 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14633
14634be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14635 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14636 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14637 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14638 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14639 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014640 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14641 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014642
14643 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14644 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14645 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14648 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14649 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14650 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014651 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14653 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014654
14655 Example :
14656 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14657 backend dynamic
14658 mode http
14659 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14660 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014661
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014662bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014663 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14664 of the string.
14665
14666bool(<bool>) : bool
14667 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14668 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14671 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014672 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014673 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14674 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014675
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014676 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014677 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014678 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14679
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014680 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14681 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014682
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014683 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014684 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014686 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014689 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014690
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014691 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14692 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014694 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014695
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014696cpu_calls : integer
14697 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14698 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14699 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14700 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14701 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14702 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14703
14704cpu_ns_avg : integer
14705 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14706 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14707 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14708 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14709 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14710 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14711 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14712 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14713 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14714 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14715 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14716
14717cpu_ns_tot : integer
14718 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14719 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14720 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14721 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14722 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14723 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14724 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14725 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14726 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14727 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14728 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14729 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14730 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14731
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014732date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014733 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014734
14735 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14736 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14737 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014738 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14739
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014740 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14741 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14742 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14743 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14744 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14745
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014746 Example :
14747
14748 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14749 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014750
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014751 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14752 # millisecond granularity
14753 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14754
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014755date_us : integer
14756 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14757 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14758 from the same timeval structure.
14759
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014760distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14761 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14762 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14763 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14764 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14765 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14766 list of supported tokens.
14767
14768distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14769 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14770 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14771 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14772 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14773 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14774 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14775 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14776 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14777 supported tokens.
14778
14779 Example :
14780 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14781 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14782 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14783 # send large files to the big farm
14784 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14785
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014786env(<name>) : string
14787 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14788 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14789 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14790 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14791 certain way.
14792
14793 Examples :
14794 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14795 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14796
14797 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14798 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14801 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014802 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14803 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14805 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014806 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14808 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014809
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014810fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14811 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14812 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14813 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14817 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14818 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14819 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14820 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14821 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14822 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14823 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014824
14825 Example :
14826 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14827 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14828 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14829 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14830 frontend mail
14831 bind :25
14832 mode tcp
14833 maxconn 100
14834 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14835 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14836 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14837 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014838
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014839hostname : string
14840 Returns the system hostname.
14841
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014842int(<integer>) : signed integer
14843 Returns a signed integer.
14844
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014845ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14846 Returns an ipv4.
14847
14848ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14849 Returns an ipv6.
14850
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014851lat_ns_avg : integer
14852 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14853 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14854 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14855 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14856 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14857 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14858 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14859 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14860 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14861 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14862 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14863 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14864 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14865 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14866
14867lat_ns_tot : integer
14868 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14869 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14870 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14871 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14872 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14873 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14874 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14875 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14876 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14877 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14878 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14879 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14880 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14881 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14882 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14883 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14884 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14885 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14886 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14887
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014888meth(<method>) : method
14889 Returns a method.
14890
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014891nbproc : integer
14892 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14893 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14894 and debugging purposes.
14895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14897 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14898 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14899 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014900 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14901 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14902 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014903
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014904prio_class : integer
14905 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14906 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14907 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14908
14909prio_offset : integer
14910 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14911 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14912 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14913 set-priority-offset".
14914
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014915proc : integer
14916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14917 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14918 debugging purposes.
14919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014921 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14922 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14923 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14925 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14926 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14927 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14928 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14929
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014930rand([<range>]) : integer
14931 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14932 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14933 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14934 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14935 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14936
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014937uuid([<version>]) : string
14938 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14939 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14940 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14943 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14944 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14945 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14946 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14947 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014948 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14949 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14950
14951srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14953 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14954 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14955 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14956 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14957 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14958 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14959
14960 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14961 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962
14963srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14964 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14965 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14966 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014967 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14969 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14970 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14971
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014972srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14973 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14974 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14975 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14976 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14977 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14978 fetch methods.
14979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14981 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14982 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014983 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14985 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014986 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987 overloading servers).
14988
14989 Example :
14990 # Redirect to a separate back
14991 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14992 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14993 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14994
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014995stopping : boolean
14996 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14997 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14998 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14999
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015000str(<string>) : string
15001 Returns a string.
15002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15004 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15005 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15006
15007table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15008 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15009 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15010 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15011
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015012thread : integer
15013 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15014 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15015 and debugging purposes.
15016
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015017var(<var-name>) : undefined
15018 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015019 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15020 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015021 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015022 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15023 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015024 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015025 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15026 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015027 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015028 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150307.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031----------------------------------
15032
15033The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15034closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15035methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15036sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15037TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015038the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15039counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015040"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15041used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15042can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15043Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15044table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15045tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15046currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015047
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015048bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015049 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15050 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15051 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053be_id : integer
15054 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15055 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15056
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015057be_name : string
15058 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15059 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061dst : ip
15062 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15063 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15064 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15065 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015066 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15067 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15068 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15069 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15070 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15071 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072
15073dst_conn : integer
15074 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15075 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15076 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15077 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15078 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15079 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15080 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15081 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015082
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015083dst_is_local : boolean
15084 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15085 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15086 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15087 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015088 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015089 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15090 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15091 it only once per connection.
15092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093dst_port : integer
15094 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15095 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15096 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15097 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15098 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15099 an HTTP header.
15100
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015101fc_http_major : integer
15102 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15103 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15104 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15105
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015106fc_pp_authority : string
15107 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15108 if any.
15109
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015110fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15111 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15112 header.
15113
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015114fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15115 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15116 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15117 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15118 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15119 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15120 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15121
15122fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15123 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15124 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15125 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15126 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15127 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15128 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15129
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015130fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015131 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15132 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15133 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15134 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15135
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015136fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015137 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15138 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15139 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15140 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15141
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015142fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015143 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15144 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15145 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15146 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15147
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015148fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015149 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15150 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15151 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15152 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15153
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015154fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015155 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15156 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15157 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15158 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15159
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015160fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015161 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15162 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15163 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15164 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15165
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015166fe_defbe : string
15167 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15168 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170fe_id : integer
15171 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015172 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15174
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015175fe_name : string
15176 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15177 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15178 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15179
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015180sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015181sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15182sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15183sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015184 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15185 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15186 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15187
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015188sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015189sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15190sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15191sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015192 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15193 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15194 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15195
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015196sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015197sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15198sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15199sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015200 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15201 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015202 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15203 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15204 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015205
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015206 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015207 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15208 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015209 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15210 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15211 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015212 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15213 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15214
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015215sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15216sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15217sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15218sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15219 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15220 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15221 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15222 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15223 when a first ACL was verified.
15224
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015225sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015226sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15227sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15228sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015229 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015230 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15231
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015232sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015233sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15234sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15235sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015236 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15237 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15238 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15239
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015240sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015241sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15242sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15243sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015244 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15245 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15246 See also src_conn_rate.
15247
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015248sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015249sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15250sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15251sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015252 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015253 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015254
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015255sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15256sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15257sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15258sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15259 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15260 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15261
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015262sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15263sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15264sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15265sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15266 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15267 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15268
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015269sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015270sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15271sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15272sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015273 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15274 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15275 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015276 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15277 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15278 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015279
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015280sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15281sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15282sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15283sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15284 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15285 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15286 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15287 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15288 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15289 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015291sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015292sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15293sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15294sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015295 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015296 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15297 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15298
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015299sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015300sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15301sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15302sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015303 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15304 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15305 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15306 src_http_err_rate.
15307
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015308sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015309sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15310sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15311sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015312 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015313 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15314 src_http_req_cnt.
15315
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015316sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015317sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15318sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15319sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015320 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15321 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15322 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15323 src_http_req_rate.
15324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015325sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015326sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15327sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15328sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015329 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015330 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15331 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15332 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15333 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015334
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015335 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015336 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15337 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015338 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15339
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015340sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15341sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15342sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15343sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15344 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15345 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15346 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15347 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15348 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15349
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015350sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015351sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15352sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15353sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015354 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15355 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15356 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015357
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015358sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015359sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15360sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15361sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015362 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15363 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15364 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015365
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015366sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015367sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15368sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15369sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015371 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15372 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15373 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015374 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015375 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015377sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015378sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15379sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15380sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015381 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15382 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15383 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15384 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15385 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015386 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015387
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015388sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015389sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15390sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15391sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015392 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15393 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15394 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015396sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015397sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15398sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15399sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015400 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15401 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015402 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015403 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15404 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15406 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15407 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409so_id : integer
15410 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15411 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15412 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015415 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15417 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15418 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015419 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15420 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15421 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015422 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15423 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15424 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15425 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15426 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15427 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15428 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015429
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015430 Example:
15431 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15432 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15435 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15436 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15437 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015438 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15441 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15442 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015443 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015444 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15447 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15448 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15449 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15450 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15451 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15452 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015453
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015454 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015455 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15456 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15457 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15458 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015459 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015460 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15461 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15462
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015463src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15464 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15465 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15466 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15467 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15468 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15469 was verified.
15470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015472 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015474 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015475 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015478 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15480 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015481 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15484 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15485 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15486 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015487 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015490 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015492 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015493 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015494
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015495src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15496 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15497 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15498 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15499 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15500
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015501src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15502 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15503 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15504 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15505 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015508 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015510 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15511 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015512 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15513 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15514 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015515
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015516src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15517 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15518 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15519 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15520 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15521 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15522 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15523 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015526 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015528 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015529 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15533 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15534 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15535 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15536 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015537 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015540 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15542 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015543 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15546 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15547 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15548 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015549 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015550 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15553 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15554 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15555 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015556 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15558 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015559
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015560 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015561 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015562 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015563 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015564
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015565src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15566 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15567 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15568 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15569 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15570 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15571 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15572
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015573src_is_local : boolean
15574 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15575 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15576 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15577 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015578 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015579 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15580 once per connection.
15581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015583 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15584 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15585 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15586 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15587 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015590 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15591 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15592 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15593 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15594 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596src_port : integer
15597 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15598 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15599 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15600 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015603 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015604 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15605 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15606 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015607 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15610 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15611 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15612 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15613 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015614 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15617 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15618 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15619 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15620 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15621 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15622 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15623 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15624 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015625
15626 Example :
15627 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15628 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15629 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15630 listen ssh
15631 bind :22
15632 mode tcp
15633 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015634 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015636 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015638srv_id : integer
15639 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15640 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15641 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015642
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015643srv_name : string
15644 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15645 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15646 debugging.
15647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156487.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15652closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15653when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15654usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015655future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015656
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001565751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15658 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15659 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15660 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15661 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15662 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15663
15664 Example :
15665 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15666 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15667 # the request.
15668 frontend http-in
15669 bind *:8081
15670 default_backend servers
15671 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15672 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15673
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015674ssl_bc : boolean
15675 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15676 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15677 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15678
15679ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15680 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15681 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15682
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015683ssl_bc_alpn : string
15684 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15685 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015686 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015687 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15688 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15689 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15690 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15691 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15692 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15693
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015694ssl_bc_cipher : string
15695 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15696 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15697
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015698ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15699 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15700 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15701 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15702
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015703ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15704 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15705 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15706 session or a TLS ticket.
15707
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015708ssl_bc_npn : string
15709 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15710 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015711 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015712 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15713 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15714 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15715 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15716 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15717
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015718ssl_bc_protocol : string
15719 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15720 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15721
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015722ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015723 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015724 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15725 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015726
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015727ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15728 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15729 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15730 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15731
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015732ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15733 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15734 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15735 if session was reused or not.
15736
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015737ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15738 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15739 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15740 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15741 BoringSSL.
15742
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015743ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15744 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15745 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15748 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15749 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15750 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15751 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15752 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15755 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15756 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15757 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15758 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015759
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015760ssl_c_der : binary
15761 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15762 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15763 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765ssl_c_err : integer
15766 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15767 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15768 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15769 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15770 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015771
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015772ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15774 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15775 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15776 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15777 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15778 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15779 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15780 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015781 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15782 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15783 LDAP v3.
15784 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15785 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787ssl_c_key_alg : string
15788 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15789 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15790 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792ssl_c_notafter : string
15793 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15794 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15795 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797ssl_c_notbefore : string
15798 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15799 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15800 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015801
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015802ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15804 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15805 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15806 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15807 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15808 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15809 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15810 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015811 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15812 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15813 LDAP v3.
15814 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15815 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817ssl_c_serial : binary
15818 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15819 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15820 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15823 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15824 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15825 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015826 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15827 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15828
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015829 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015830 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015832ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15833 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15834 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15835 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837ssl_c_used : boolean
15838 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15839 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841ssl_c_verify : integer
15842 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15843 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15844 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15845 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847ssl_c_version : integer
15848 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15849 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015850
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015851ssl_f_der : binary
15852 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15853 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15854 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15855
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015856ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15858 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15859 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15860 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015861 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15863 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15864 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015865 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15866 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15867 LDAP v3.
15868 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15869 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871ssl_f_key_alg : string
15872 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15873 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15874 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_f_notafter : string
15877 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15878 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15879 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881ssl_f_notbefore : string
15882 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15883 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15884 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015885
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015886ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15888 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15889 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15890 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15891 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15892 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15893 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15894 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015895 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15896 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15897 LDAP v3.
15898 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15899 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901ssl_f_serial : binary
15902 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15903 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15904 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015905
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015906ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15907 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15908 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15909 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15912 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15913 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15914 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916ssl_f_version : integer
15917 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15918 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15919
15920ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015921 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15922 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15923 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925 Example :
15926 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15927 listen http-https
15928 bind :80
15929 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15930 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15931
15932ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15933 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15934 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15935
15936ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015937 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15939 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15940 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15941 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15942 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15943 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15944 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15945 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947ssl_fc_cipher : string
15948 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15949 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015950
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015951ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15952 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15953 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015954 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015955
15956ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15957 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15958 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015959 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015960
15961ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15962 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15963 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15964 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015965 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015966 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015967
15968ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15969 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15970 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015971 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015972
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015973ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15974 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15975 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15976 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015979 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15980 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015981 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15982 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15983 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15984 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015985
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015986ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15987 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15988 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15989 wait until the handshake happened.
15990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15992 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015993 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15994 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015995 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015996 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015997
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015998ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015999 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016000 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16001 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016004 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16006 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16007 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16008 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16009 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16010 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16011 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013ssl_fc_protocol : string
16014 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16015 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016016
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016017ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016018 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016019 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16020 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016021
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016022ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16023 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16024 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16025 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16028 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16029 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16030 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16031 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016032
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016033ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16034 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16035 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16036 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16037 BoringSSL.
16038
16039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040ssl_fc_sni : string
16041 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16042 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16043 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16044 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16045 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16046
16047 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16048 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16049 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016050 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016051 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16055 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16058 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16059 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016060
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16066sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16067only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16068For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16069be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16070can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16071sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16072for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16073content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016076 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16078 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16081 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016082 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016083 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016084
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016085req.hdrs : string
16086 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16087 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16088 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16089 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16090
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016091req.hdrs_bin : binary
16092 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16093 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16094 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16095 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16096 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16097 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16098
16099 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16100
16101 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16102 str: <int:length><bytes>
16103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104req.len : integer
16105req_len : integer (deprecated)
16106 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16107 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16108 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16109 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16110 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16111 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16112 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16113 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16116 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016117 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16118 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16119 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16120 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122 ACL alternatives :
16123 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016125req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16126 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16127 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16128 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16129 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131 ACL alternatives :
16132 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136req.proto_http : boolean
16137req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16138 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16139 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16140 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16141 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16142 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16143 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16144 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 Example:
16147 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16148 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16149 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016150 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16153rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16154 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16155 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16156 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16157 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16158 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16159 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16160 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16163 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16164 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16165 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16166 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16167 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169 ACL derivatives :
16170 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172 Example :
16173 listen tse-farm
16174 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16175 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16176 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16177 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16178 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16179 persist rdp-cookie
16180 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16181 # This is only useful makes sense if
16182 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16183 stick-table type string size 204800
16184 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16185 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16186 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016188 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16189 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16192rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16193 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16194 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16195 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16196 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198 ACL derivatives :
16199 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016200
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016201req.ssl_alpn : string
16202 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16203 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16204 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16205 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16206 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16207 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016208 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016209
16210 Examples :
16211 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16212 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16213 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016214 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016215 default_backend bk_default
16216
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016217req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16218 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16219 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016220 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16221 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16222 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16223 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16224 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16227req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16228 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16229 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16230 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16231 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16232 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16233 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16234 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236req.ssl_sni : string
16237req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16238 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16239 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16240 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16241 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16242 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16243 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16244 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16245 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16246 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16247 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16248 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16249 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251 ACL derivatives :
16252 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254 Examples :
16255 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16256 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16257 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16258 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16259 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016260
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016261req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16262 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16263 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16264 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16265 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16266 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16267 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16268 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16269 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16270 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272req.ssl_ver : integer
16273req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16274 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16275 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16276 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16277 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16278 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16279 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16280 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016281 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016284 ACL derivatives :
16285 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016286
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016287res.len : integer
16288 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16289 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16290 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16291 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16292 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16293 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16294 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16295 content inspection.
16296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016297res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16298 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016299 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16300 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16301 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16302 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016304res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16305 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16306 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16307 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16308 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016311
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016312res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16313rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16314 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16315 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16316 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16317 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16318 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16319 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16320 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322wait_end : boolean
16323 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16324 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016325 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016326 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16327 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016328 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16330 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016332 Examples :
16333 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16334 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16335 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16338 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16339 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16340 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16341 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16342 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16343 tcp-request content reject
16344
16345
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163467.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016347--------------------------------------
16348
16349It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16350This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16351data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16352its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16353HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16354content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16355to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16356more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16357response are indexed.
16358
16359base : string
16360 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16361 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16362 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16363 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16364 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16365 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16366 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16367 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16368
16369 ACL derivatives :
16370 base : exact string match
16371 base_beg : prefix match
16372 base_dir : subdir match
16373 base_dom : domain match
16374 base_end : suffix match
16375 base_len : length match
16376 base_reg : regex match
16377 base_sub : substring match
16378
16379base32 : integer
16380 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16381 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16382 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016383 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16384 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16385 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386
16387base32+src : binary
16388 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16389 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16390 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16391 per-URL counters.
16392
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016393capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16394 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16395 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16396 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16397
16398capture.req.method : string
16399 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16400 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16401 because it's allocated.
16402
16403capture.req.uri : string
16404 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16405 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16406 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16407 allocated.
16408
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016409capture.req.ver : string
16410 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16411 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16412 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16413
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016414capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16415 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16416 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16417 The first entry is an index of 0.
16418 See also: "capture response header"
16419
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016420capture.res.ver : string
16421 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16422 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16423 persistent flag.
16424
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016425req.body : binary
16426 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16427 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16428 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16429 the first chunk is analyzed.
16430
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016431req.body_param([<name>) : string
16432 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16433 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16434 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16435 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16436 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16437 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16438 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16439 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16440 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16441 given.
16442
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016443req.body_len : integer
16444 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16445 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16446 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16447 "option http-buffer-request".
16448
16449req.body_size : integer
16450 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16451 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16452 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16453 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16454 "option http-buffer-request".
16455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016456req.cook([<name>]) : string
16457cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16458 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16459 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16460 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16461 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16462 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16463 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16464 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16465 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16466
16467 ACL derivatives :
16468 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16469 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16470 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16471 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16472 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16473 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16474 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16475 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16478cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16479 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16480 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16483cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16484 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16485 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16486 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16487 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16490 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16491 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16492 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16493 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016494 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016495 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16496 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16497 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16498 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16501 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16502 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16503 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16504 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016505 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16508 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16509 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16510 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16511 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16512 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16513 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16514 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16515 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016517req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16518 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16519 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16520 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16521 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16524 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16525 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16526 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16527 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16528 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16529 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16530 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16531 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016532 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016533 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016534 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536 ACL derivatives :
16537 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16538 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16539 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16540 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16541 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16542 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16543 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16544 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16545
16546req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16547hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16548 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16549 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16550 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16551 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16552 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16553 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16554 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16555 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16556 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16557
16558req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16559hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16560 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16561 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16562 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16563 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16564 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016565 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16567 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16568
16569req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16570hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16571 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16572 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16573 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16574 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16575 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16576 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16577 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16578
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016579
16580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016581http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16582 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16583 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16584 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16585 basic auth is supported.
16586
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016587http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16588 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16589 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16590 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16591 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16593 basic auth is supported.
16594
16595 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016596 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16597 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16598 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16599 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016601http_auth_pass : string
16602 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16603 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16604 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16605
16606http_auth_type : string
16607 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16608 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16609 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16610
16611http_auth_user : string
16612 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16613 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16614 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016617 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16618 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016619 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16620 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016622method : integer + string
16623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16624 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16625 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16626 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16627 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16628 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16629 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016631 ACL derivatives :
16632 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634 Example :
16635 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16636 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16637 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639path : string
16640 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16641 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16642 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16643 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16644 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016645 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016646 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016648 ACL derivatives :
16649 path : exact string match
16650 path_beg : prefix match
16651 path_dir : subdir match
16652 path_dom : domain match
16653 path_end : suffix match
16654 path_len : length match
16655 path_reg : regex match
16656 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016657
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016658query : string
16659 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16660 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16661 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16662 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016663 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016664 which stops before the question mark.
16665
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016666req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16667 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16668 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16669 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16670 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672req.ver : string
16673req_ver : string (deprecated)
16674 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16675 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16676 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016678 ACL derivatives :
16679 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016681res.comp : boolean
16682 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16683 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16684 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686res.comp_algo : string
16687 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16688 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16689 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016691res.cook([<name>]) : string
16692scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16693 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16694 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16695 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016697 ACL derivatives :
16698 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016700res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16701scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16702 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16703 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16704 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016706res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16707scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16708 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16709 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16710 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16713 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16714 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16715 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16716 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16717 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16718 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16719 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16720 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16721 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16725 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16726 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16727 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16728 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16731shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16732 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16733 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16734 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16735 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16736 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16737 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16738 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16739 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016741 ACL derivatives :
16742 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16743 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16744 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16745 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16746 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16747 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16748 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16749 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16750
16751res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16752shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16753 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16754 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16755 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16756 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16757 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16760shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16761 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16762 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16763 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16764 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16765 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16766 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016767
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016768res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16769 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16770 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16771 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16772 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016774res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16775shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16776 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16777 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16778 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16779 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16780 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16781 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783res.ver : string
16784resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16785 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16786 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788 ACL derivatives :
16789 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016791set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16792 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16793 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016794 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16798 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016800status : integer
16801 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16802 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16803 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016804
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016805unique-id : string
16806 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16807 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16808 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16809 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16810 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16811 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813url : string
16814 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16815 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16816 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16817 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16818 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16819 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16820 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822 ACL derivatives :
16823 url : exact string match
16824 url_beg : prefix match
16825 url_dir : subdir match
16826 url_dom : domain match
16827 url_end : suffix match
16828 url_len : length match
16829 url_reg : regex match
16830 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832url_ip : ip
16833 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16834 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16835 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16836 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16837 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16838 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16839 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841url_port : integer
16842 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16843 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16844 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16845 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016846
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016847urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16848url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16850 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016851 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16852 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16853 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16854 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16856 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016857 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16858 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016860 ACL derivatives :
16861 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16862 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16863 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16864 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16865 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16866 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16867 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16868 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016869
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871 Example :
16872 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16873 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16874 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16875 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016876
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016877urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16879 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16880 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016881
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016882url32 : integer
16883 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16884 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16885 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16886 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16887 is an unsigned integer.
16888
16889url32+src : binary
16890 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16891 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16892 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16893
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016894
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100168957.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16896---------------------------------------
16897
16898This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16899used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16900purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16901There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16902or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16903any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16904for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16905
16906internal.htx.data : integer
16907 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16908 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16909
16910internal.htx.free : integer
16911 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16912 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16913
16914internal.htx.free_data : integer
16915 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16916 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16917
16918internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16919 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16920 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16921 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16922
16923internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16924 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16925 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16926
16927internal.htx.size : integer
16928 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16929 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16930
16931internal.htx.used : integer
16932 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16933 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16934 direction.
16935
16936internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16937 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16938 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16939 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16940 of the special value :
16941 * head : The oldest inserted block
16942 * tail : The newest inserted block
16943 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16944
16945internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16946 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16947 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16948 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16949 integer or one of the special value :
16950 * head : The oldest inserted block
16951 * tail : The newest inserted block
16952 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16953
16954internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16955 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16956 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16957 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16958 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16959
16960 * head : The oldest inserted block
16961 * tail : The newest inserted block
16962 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16963
16964internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16965 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16966 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16967 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16968 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16969
16970 * head : The oldest inserted block
16971 * tail : The newest inserted block
16972 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16973
16974internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16975 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16976 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16977 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16978 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16979
16980 * head : The oldest inserted block
16981 * tail : The newest inserted block
16982 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16983
16984internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16985 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16986 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16987 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16988 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16989
16990 * head : The oldest inserted block
16991 * tail : The newest inserted block
16992 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16993
16994internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16995 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16996 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16997 it returns false.
16998
16999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170007.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017001---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017003Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17004every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017005order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017007ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17008---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017009FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017010HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017011HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17012HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017013HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17014HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17015HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17016HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17017LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017018METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017019METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017020METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17021METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17022METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17023METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017024METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017025METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017026RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017027REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017028TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017029WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17030---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017031
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170338. Logging
17034----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017036One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17037provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17038very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17039provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17040state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017041to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017042headers.
17043
17044In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17045about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17046send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17047
17048 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17049 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17050 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17051 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17052 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017053 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017054 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017055
17056The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17057allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17058as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17059while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17060real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17061delay.
17062
17063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170648.1. Log levels
17065---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017066
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017067TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017069HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17070in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17071track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17072syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17073about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017074
17075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170768.2. Log formats
17077----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017078
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017079HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017080and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17081slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17082options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083
17084 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17085 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17086 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17087 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17088 extents.
17089
17090 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17091 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17092 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17093 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17094 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17095
17096 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17097 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17098 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17099 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17100 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17101
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017102 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17103 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17104 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17105 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17106
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017107 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017109Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17110specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17111field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17112servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17113always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17114identifier.
17115
17116Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17117 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17118 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17119 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17120 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17121
17122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171238.2.1. Default log format
17124-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017125
17126This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17127as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17128format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17129
17130 Example :
17131 listen www
17132 mode http
17133 log global
17134 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17135
17136 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17137 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17138 (www/HTTP)
17139
17140 Field Format Extract from the example above
17141 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17142 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17143 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17144 4 'to' to
17145 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17146 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17147
17148Detailed fields description :
17149 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17150 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17151 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17152 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17153 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17154 and processed the connection.
17155 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17156
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017157In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17158"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17159connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17162will eventually disappear.
17163
17164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171658.2.2. TCP log format
17166---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017167
17168The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17169is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17170information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17171counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17172emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17173environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17174the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17175sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017176specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17177not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17178fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17179marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017180
17181 Example :
17182 frontend fnt
17183 mode tcp
17184 option tcplog
17185 log global
17186 default_backend bck
17187
17188 backend bck
17189 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17190
17191 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17192 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17193 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17194
17195 Field Format Extract from the example above
17196 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17197 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17198 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17199 4 frontend_name fnt
17200 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17201 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17202 7 bytes_read* 212
17203 8 termination_state --
17204 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17205 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17206
17207Detailed fields description :
17208 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017209 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17210 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17211 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017212 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017213 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017214 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215
17216 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017217 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17218 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17219 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017220
17221 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17222 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17223 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017224 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17225 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17226 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17227 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228
17229 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17230 and processed the connection.
17231
17232 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17233 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17234 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17235 applications.
17236
17237 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17238 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17239 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17240 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17241 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17242
17243 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17244 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17245 See "Timers" below for more details.
17246
17247 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17248 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17249 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17250 "Timers" below for more details.
17251
17252 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017253 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017254 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17255 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17256 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17257 details.
17258
17259 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17260 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17261 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17262 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17263 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17264
17265 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17266 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17267 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17268 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17269 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17270 for more details.
17271
17272 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017273 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017274 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17275 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17276 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017277 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278
17279 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17280 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17281 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17282 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17283 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17284 caused by a denial of service attack.
17285
17286 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17287 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17288 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17289 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17290 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17291 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17292 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17293 denial of service attack.
17294
17295 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17296 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17297 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17298 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17299 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17300 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17301 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17302 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17303 be processed than on other servers.
17304
17305 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17306 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17307 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17308 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17309 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17310 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17311 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17312 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17313 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17314 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17315 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17316 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17317 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17318
17319 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17320 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17321 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17322 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17323 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17324 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017325 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017326 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17327
17328 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17329 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17330 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17331 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17332 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17333 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017334 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017335 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17336 occurs.
17337
17338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173398.2.3. HTTP log format
17340----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017341
17342The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17343is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17344the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17345are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17346emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17347generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17348"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17349which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017350frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17351is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352
17353Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17354slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17355with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17356
17357 Example :
17358 frontend http-in
17359 mode http
17360 option httplog
17361 log global
17362 default_backend bck
17363
17364 backend static
17365 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17366
17367 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17368 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17369 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017370 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017371
17372 Field Format Extract from the example above
17373 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17374 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017375 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376 4 frontend_name http-in
17377 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017378 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017379 7 status_code 200
17380 8 bytes_read* 2750
17381 9 captured_request_cookie -
17382 10 captured_response_cookie -
17383 11 termination_state ----
17384 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17385 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17386 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17387 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17388 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017389
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390Detailed fields description :
17391 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017392 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17393 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17394 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017395 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017396 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017397 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017398
17399 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017400 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17401 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17402 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017404 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17405 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406
17407 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17408 and processed the connection.
17409
17410 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17411 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17412 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17413
17414 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17415 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17416 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17417 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17418 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17419 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17420
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017421 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17422 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17423 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017424 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017425 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17426 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017427 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17428 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017429
17430 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17431 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017432 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017433
17434 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17435 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017436 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17437 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017438
17439 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17440 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17441 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17442 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17443 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017444 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17445 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017446
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017447 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17448 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17449 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17450 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17451 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17452 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17453 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017454 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017455
17456 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17457 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17458 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17459
17460 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17461 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017462 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017463 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17464 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17465 overflowing.
17466
17467 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17468 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17469 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17470 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17471 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17472 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17473 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17474 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17475
17476 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17477 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17478 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17479 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17480 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17481 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17482 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17483 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17484
17485 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17486 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17487 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17488 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17489 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17490 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17491 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17492
17493 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017494 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017495 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17496 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17497 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017498 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017499 system.
17500
17501 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17502 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17503 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17504 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17505 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17506 caused by a denial of service attack.
17507
17508 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17509 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17510 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17511 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17512 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17513 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17514 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17515 denial of service attack.
17516
17517 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17518 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17519 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17520 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17521 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17522 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17523 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17524 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17525 processed than on other servers.
17526
17527 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17528 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17529 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17530 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17531 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17532 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17533 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17534 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17535 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17536 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17537 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17538 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17539 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17540
17541 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17542 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17543 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17544 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17545 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17546 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017547 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017548 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17549
17550 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17551 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17552 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17553 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17554 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17555 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017556 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017557 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17558 occurs.
17559
17560 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17561 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17562 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17563 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17564 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17565 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17566 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17567 cookies" below for more details.
17568
17569 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17570 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17571 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17572 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17573 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17574 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17575 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17576 and cookies" below for more details.
17577
17578 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17579 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17580 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17581 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17582 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17583 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17584 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17585 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17586
17587
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175888.2.4. Custom log format
17589------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017590
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017591The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017592mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017594HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017595Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17596separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17597prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17598
17599Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17600variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017601("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017602
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017603If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017604as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017605less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17606the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17607
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017608Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017609In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017610in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017611
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017612Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17613'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17614https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17615such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017617Flags are :
17618 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017619 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017620 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17621 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017622
17623 Example:
17624
17625 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17626 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17627
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017628 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17629
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017630At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17631
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017632 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17633 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017634
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017635the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017637 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17638 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17639 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017640
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017641and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17642
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017643 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17644 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017645
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017646Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17647
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017648 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017649 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017650 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17651 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17652 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017653 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17654 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17655 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017656 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017657 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17658 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017659 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017660 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17661 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017662 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017663 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017664 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017665 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017666 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017667 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017668 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017669 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17670 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17671 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17672 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17673 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017674 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017675 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17676 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017677 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017678 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17679 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017680 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17681 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17682 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017683 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017684 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17685 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017686 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017687 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17688 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17689 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017690 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017691 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017692 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17693 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17694 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17695 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017696 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017697 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017698 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017699 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017700 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017701 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017702 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17703 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17704 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017705 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017706 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17707 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017708 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017709 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17710 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017711 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017712 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017713 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017714 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017715
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017716 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017717
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017718
177198.2.5. Error log format
17720-----------------------
17721
17722When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17723protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17724By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17725"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017726will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017727logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17728
17729The format looks like this :
17730
17731 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17732 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17733 Connection error during SSL handshake
17734
17735 Field Format Extract from the example above
17736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17737 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17738 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17739 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17740 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17741
17742These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17743failures.
17744
17745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177468.3. Advanced logging options
17747-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017748
17749Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17750just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17751options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17752for more information about their usage.
17753
17754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177558.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17756------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017757
17758It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17759haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17760commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17761monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17762ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17763
17764 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17765 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17766 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17767 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17768
17769 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17770 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17771 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017772 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017773 such as other load-balancers.
17774
17775 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17776 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17777 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17778
17779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17781----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017782
17783The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17784what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17785or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017786"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017787just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17788log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17789after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17790is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17791with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17792with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17793
17794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177958.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17796------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017797
17798Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17799for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17800"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17801retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17802raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17803a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17804file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17805you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17806"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17807
17808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17810--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017811
17812Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17813multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17814them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17815"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17816logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17817error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17818and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17819too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17820useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17821alternative.
17822
17823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178248.4. Timing events
17825------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017826
17827Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17828reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17829the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17830frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017831mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17832addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17833
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017834Timings events in HTTP mode:
17835
17836 first request 2nd request
17837 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17838 t tr t tr ...
17839 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17840 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17841 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17842 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17843 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17844
17845Timings events in TCP mode:
17846
17847 TCP session
17848 |<----------------->|
17849 t t
17850 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17851 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17852 |<------ Tt ------->|
17853
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017854 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017855 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017856 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17857 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17858 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017859 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017860 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17861 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17862 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17863 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017865 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17866 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17867 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017868 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17869 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17870 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17871 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17872 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17873 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017874
17875 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17876 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17877 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17878 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17879 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17880 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17881 request typed by hand during a test.
17882
17883 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17884 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017885 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017886 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17887 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17888 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17889 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017890
17891 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17892 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17893 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17894 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17895 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17896
17897 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17898 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17899 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17900 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17901 connection never established.
17902
17903 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17904 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17905 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17906 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17907 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17908 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17909 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17910 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17911 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17912 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17913 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017915 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17916 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17917 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17918 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17919 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17920 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17921
17922 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17923
17924 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17925 "Ta" can never be negative.
17926
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017927 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17928 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017929 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17930 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017931 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017932
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017933 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017934
17935 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017936 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17937 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017938
17939These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17940protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17941that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017942due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17943"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17944that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017945
17946Most common cases :
17947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017948 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17949 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17950 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17951 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17952 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17953 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17954 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17955 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17956 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17957 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17958 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017959 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017960
17961 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17962 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17963 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17964 of ms on remote networks.
17965
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017966 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17967 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17968 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017969
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017970 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17971 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17972 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17973 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17974 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17975 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17976 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17977 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17978 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017979
17980Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17981
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017982 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017983 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017984 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017985
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017986 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017987 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17988 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17989
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017990 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017991 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17992 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17993 flags.
17994
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017995 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17996 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017997 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17998 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17999 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18000 the client connection was maintained open.
18001
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018002 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018003 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018004 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018005 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18006
18007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180088.5. Session state at disconnection
18009-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018010
18011TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18012"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
180132-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18014each of which has a special meaning :
18015
18016 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18017 session to terminate :
18018
18019 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18020
18021 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18022 server explicitly refused it.
18023
18024 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18025 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18026 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18027 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018028 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018029
18030 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18031 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018032
18033 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18034 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18035 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18036 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18037 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18038
18039 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18040 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18041 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18042 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18043 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18044
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018045 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18046 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18047
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018048 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18049 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18050 backup connections when going up.
18051
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018052 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18053
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018054 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18055 send or receive data.
18056
18057 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18058 send or receive data.
18059
18060 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18061 with nothing left in the buffers.
18062
18063 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18064
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018065 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018066 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18067
18068 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18069 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18070 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18071 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18072 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18073
18074 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18075 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18076
18077 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18078 server (HTTP only).
18079
18080 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18081
18082 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18083 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18084 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18085
18086 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18087 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18088 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18089
18090 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18091
18092 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18093 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18094
18095 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18096 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18097 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18098
18099 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18100 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018101 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18102 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103
18104 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18105 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18106 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18107 another server.
18108
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018109 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018110 server.
18111
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018112 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18113 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18114 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18115 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18116
18117 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18118 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18119 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18120 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18121
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018122 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18123 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18124 "use-server" rule).
18125
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018126 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18127
18128 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18129 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18130
18131 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18132
18133 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18134 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18135 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18136
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018137 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18138 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018139 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018140 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18141 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018143 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18144
18145 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18146 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18147
18148 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18149
18150 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18151
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018152The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18153was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018154helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18155starvation, attacks, etc...
18156
18157The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18158alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18159easier finding and understanding.
18160
18161 Flags Reason
18162
18163 -- Normal termination.
18164
18165 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18166 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18167 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18168 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18169
18170 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18171 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18172 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18173 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18174 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18175 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018176
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018177 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18178 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018179 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180
18181 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18182 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18183 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18184
18185 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18186 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18187 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18188 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18189 the server takes too long to respond.
18190
18191 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18192 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18193 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18194 long a time to respond.
18195
18196 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18197 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18198 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18199 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018200 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18201 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018202
18203 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18204 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18205 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18206 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18207 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018208 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018209 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18210 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18211 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18212 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18213 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18214 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18215 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18216 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018217 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018218 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18219 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18220 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018221
18222 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18223 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018224 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18225 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18226 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18227 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018228
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018229 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18230 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018232 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018233 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18234 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018235 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018236 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18237 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18238
18239 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18240 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18241 503 or 504 here.
18242
18243 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18244 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18245 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18246 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18247 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18248
18249 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18250 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018251 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018252 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18253 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18254
18255 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18256 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18257 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18258 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18259 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18260 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18261 between haproxy and the server.
18262
18263 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18264 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18265 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18266 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18267 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18268 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18269 solution is to fix the application.
18270
18271 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18272 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18273 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18274 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18275 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18276 external attacks.
18277
18278 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18279 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018280 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018281 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18282 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18283
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018284 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18285 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18286 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018287 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018288 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018289
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018290 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18291 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18292 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18293 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018294 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18295 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18296 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18297 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18298 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018299
18300 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18301 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18302 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18303 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18304
18305 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18306 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18307 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18308 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18309
18310 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18311 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18312 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18313 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18314
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018315The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18316persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18317important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18318re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18319
18320 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18321
18322 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18323 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18324 set on a GET request.
18325
18326 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18327 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018328 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018329 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18330
18331 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18332 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18333 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18334
18335 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18336 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18337 already got a cookie.
18338
18339 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18340 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18341 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18342 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18343 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18344
18345 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18346 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18347 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18348
18349 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18350 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18351 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18352
18353 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18354 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18355
18356 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18357 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18358 then advertised in the response.
18359
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183618.6. Non-printable characters
18362-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018363
18364In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18365consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18366converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18367prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18368being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18369escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18370is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18371'}' when logging headers.
18372
18373Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18374issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18375containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18376
18377Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18378the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18379performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18380
18381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183828.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18383---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018384
18385Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18386achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018387section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018388cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18389the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18390the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018391locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018392not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18393user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18394a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18395wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18396
18397 Examples :
18398 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18399 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18400
18401 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18402 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18403
18404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184058.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18406---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018407
18408Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18409proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18410the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18411server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18412
18413Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18414response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018415section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018416
18417It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018418time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18419appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018420are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18421and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18422follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18423request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18424in the logs.
18425
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018426As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18427frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18428an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18429
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018430 Example :
18431 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18432 listen proxy-out
18433 mode http
18434 option httplog
18435 option logasap
18436 log global
18437 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18438
18439 # log the name of the virtual server
18440 capture request header Host len 20
18441
18442 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18443 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18444
18445 # log the beginning of the referrer
18446 capture request header Referer len 20
18447
18448 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18449 capture response header Server len 20
18450
18451 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18452 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18453
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018454 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018455 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18456
18457 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18458 capture response header Via len 20
18459
18460 # log the URL location during a redirection
18461 capture response header Location len 20
18462
18463 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18464 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18465 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18466 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18467 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18468
18469 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18470 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18471 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18472 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018473 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018474
18475 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18476 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18477 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18478 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18479 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018480 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018481
18482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184838.9. Examples of logs
18484---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018485
18486These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18487them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18488reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18489
18490 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18491 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18492 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18493
18494 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18495 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18496
18497 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18498 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18499 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18500
18501 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18502 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18503
18504 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18505 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18506 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18507
18508 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018509 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018510 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18511 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18512
18513 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18514 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18515 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18516
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018517 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18518 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18519 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18520 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18521 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18522 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018523
18524 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018525 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018526
18527 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18528 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18529 Nothing was sent to any server.
18530
18531 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18532 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18533
18534 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18535 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018536 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018537 send a 408 return code to the client.
18538
18539 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18540 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18541
18542 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18543 5 seconds ("c----").
18544
18545 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18546 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018547 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018548
18549 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018550 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018551 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18552 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18553 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18554 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18555 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018556
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018557
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185589. Supported filters
18559--------------------
18560
18561Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18562accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18563unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18564
18565See also : "filter"
18566
185679.1. Trace
18568----------
18569
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018570filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018571
18572 Arguments:
18573 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18574 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18575
18576 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18577 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18578 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18579 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18580
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018581 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018582 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18583 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18584 amount of the parsed data.
18585
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018586 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018587
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018588This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18589callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18590information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18591filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18592
18593Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18594tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18595a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18596
18597
185989.2. HTTP compression
18599---------------------
18600
18601filter compression
18602
18603The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18604keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018605when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18606fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18607done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18608explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18609filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18610listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18611order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018612
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018613See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18614 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018615
18616
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200186179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18618--------------------------------------------
18619
18620filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18621
18622 Arguments :
18623
18624 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18625 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18626 parsed.
18627
18628 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18629 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18630 part must be placed in its own scope.
18631
18632The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18633external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018634streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018635exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18636also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18637
18638SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18639the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18640
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018641For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018642"doc/SPOE.txt".
18643
18644Important note:
18645 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18646 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18647
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186489.4. Cache
18649----------
18650
18651filter cache <name>
18652
18653 Arguments :
18654
18655 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18656
18657The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18658"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018659cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018660other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18661case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18662is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18663filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018664listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18665order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018666
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018667See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18668 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18669
18670
186719.5. Fcgi-app
18672-------------
18673
18674filter fcg-app <name>
18675
18676 Arguments :
18677
18678 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18679
18680The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18681request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18682reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18683used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18684implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18685used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18686fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18687used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18688order.
18689
18690See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18691 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18692
18693
1869410. FastCGI applications
18695-------------------------
18696
18697HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18698feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18699the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18700FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18701servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18702FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18703backend.
18704
18705HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18706application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18707connection.
18708
1870910.1. Setup
18710-----------
18711
1871210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18713--------------------------
18714
18715fcgi-app <name>
18716 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18717 document root must be defined.
18718
18719acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18720 Declare or complete an access list.
18721
18722 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18723 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18724 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18725 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18726 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18727
18728docroot <path>
18729 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18730 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18731 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18732
18733index <script-name>
18734 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18735 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18736 is an optional setting.
18737
18738 Example :
18739 index index.php
18740
18741log-stderr global
18742log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18743 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18744 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18745
18746 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18747 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18748
18749pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18750 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18751 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18752 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18753
18754 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18755 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18756 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18757 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18758
18759 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18760 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18761
18762path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018763 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018764 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18765 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18766 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18767 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18768 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18769 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18770 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018771
18772 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
18773 the null characters are forbiden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
18774 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18775 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18776 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18777 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018778
18779 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018780 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18781 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018782
18783option get-values
18784no option get-values
18785 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18786
18787 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18788 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18789
18790 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18791 application will accept.
18792
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018793 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18794 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018795
18796 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18797 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18798 option is disabled.
18799
18800 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18801 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18802 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18803 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18804 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18805 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18806
18807option keep-conn
18808no option keep-conn
18809 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18810 sending a response.
18811
18812 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18813 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18814
18815option max-reqs <reqs>
18816 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18817 accept.
18818
18819 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18820 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18821 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18822 to 1.
18823
18824option mpxs-conns
18825no option mpxs-conns
18826 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18827
18828 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18829 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18830
18831set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18832 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18833 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18834 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18835 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18836
18837 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18838 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18839 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18840
18841 Example :
18842 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18843 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18844
18845 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18846
18847
1884810.1.2. Proxy section
18849---------------------
18850
18851use-fcgi-app <name>
18852 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18853
18854 Arguments :
18855 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18856
18857 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18858 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18859 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18860 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18861 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18862
18863 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18864 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18865 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18866 application are evaluated.
18867
18868
1886910.1.3. Example
18870---------------
18871
18872 frontend front-http
18873 mode http
18874 bind *:80
18875 bind *:
18876
18877 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18878 default_backend back-static
18879
18880 backend back-static
18881 mode http
18882 server www A.B.C.D:80
18883
18884 backend back-dynamic
18885 mode http
18886 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18887 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18888
18889 fcgi-app php-fpm
18890 log-stderr global
18891 option keep-conn
18892
18893 docroot /var/www/my-app
18894 index index.php
18895 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18896
18897
1889810.2. Default parameters
18899------------------------
18900
18901A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18902the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18903scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18904applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18905
18906 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18907 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18908 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18909 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18910 | | |
18911 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18912 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18913 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18914 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18915 | | application. |
18916 | | |
18917 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18918 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18919 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18920 | | |
18921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18922 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18923 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18924 | | the application's configuration. |
18925 | | |
18926 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18927 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18928 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18929 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18930 | | |
18931 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18932 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18933 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18934 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18935 | | be defined. |
18936 | | |
18937 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18938 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18939 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18940 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18941 | | is not set too. |
18942 | | |
18943 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18944 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18945 | | set. |
18946 | | |
18947 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18948 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18949 | | the request. |
18950 | | |
18951 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18952 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18953 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18954 | | |
18955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18956 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18957 | | script to process the request. |
18958 | | |
18959 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18960 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18961 | | |
18962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18963 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18964 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18965 | | |
18966 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18967 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18968 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18969 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18970 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18971 | | |
18972 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18973 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18974 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18975 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18976 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18977 | | side. |
18978 | | |
18979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18980 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18981 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18982 | | connected to. |
18983 | | |
18984 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18985 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18986 | | |
18987 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18988 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18989 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18990 | | |
18991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18992
18993
1899410.3. Limitations
18995------------------
18996
18997The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18998way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18999during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19000establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19001application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19002or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19003message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19004these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19005and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19006
19007Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19008request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19009requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19010
19011About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19012into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19013fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19014"http-request" ones.
19015
19016Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19017FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19018processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19019must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19020here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019022/*
19023 * Local variables:
19024 * fill-column: 79
19025 * End:
19026 */